Xerox Printer WorkCentre 3215 User Manual

July 2014  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215NI  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3225DN/  
3225DNI  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
1
2
iii  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
iv  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
3
v
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
vi  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Scan Using TWAIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
vii  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
9
viii  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
ix  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
x
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
xi  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
xii  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Started  
1
This chapter includes:  
Machine Overview  
Product Configurations  
Control Panel Overview  
Powering On the Machine  
Software  
Information Pages  
Feature Defaults  
Accessing the Printer  
More Information  
Further Assistance  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Machine Overview  
Machine Overview  
Before you use your machine, take some time to familiarize yourself with the various features and  
options.  
Front View  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Document Feeder Cover  
Document Feeder Input Tray  
Document Feeder Output Support  
Control Panel  
8
Manual Feeder Slot  
9
Output Tray  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
Output Support  
Paper Width Guide on Manual Feeder  
Document Cover  
Front Cover  
Paper Level Indicator  
Paper Tray 1  
Platen Glass  
Paper Width Guide on Document Feeder  
2
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Machine Overview  
Rear View  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Network Port  
Telephone Line Socket (Line)  
Extension Telephone Socket (EXT)  
Rear Cover  
Power Receptacle  
USB Port  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Product Configurations  
Product Configurations  
WorkCentre  
3215NI  
WorkCentre  
3225DNI  
WorkCentre  
3225DN  
Component  
Automatic Document Feeder  
Paper Tray (250 sheets)  
Manual Feeder Slot (1 sheet)  
Output Tray (120 sheets)  
AirPrint  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Not Applicable  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Not Applicable  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Not Applicable  
Not Applicable  
Standard  
Google Cloud Print  
Network Printing  
Copy  
Standard  
Scan  
Standard  
Fax  
Standard  
E-mail  
Standard  
USB Device  
Standard  
USB Host  
Not Applicable  
Not Applicable  
Not Applicable  
Wi-Fi  
Wi-Fi DirectTM  
4
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Control Panel Overview  
Control Panel Overview  
The control panel consists of a display, a keypad, and buttons you press to control the functions  
available on the printer. The control panel:  
Displays the current operating status of the printer.  
Provides access to copy, print, scan, e-mail, and fax features.  
Provides access to information pages.  
Prompts you to load paper, replace supplies, and clear jams.  
Displays errors and warnings.  
.
Number  
Button  
Description  
1
Copy: Activates Copy mode.  
Scan: Activates Scan mode.  
2
3
4
Display Screen: Displays all the available programming features, plus  
general machine information.  
E-mail: Activates E-mail mode.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Control Panel Overview  
Number  
Button  
Description  
5-6  
17-18  
Menu: Enters Menu mode and enables you to access options and  
settings.  
Arrows: The up and down arrows are used to scroll through the  
options available in the selected menu, and to increase or decrease  
values.  
Back: Sends the user back to the higher menu level.  
OK: Confirms the selection on the screen.  
7
Address Book: Used to search for stored fax numbers or e-mail  
addresses.  
8
9
15  
Keypad: Used to enter alphanumeric characters.  
Pause / Redial: In standby mode redials the last number. In edit mode  
inserts a pause into a fax number.  
Clear: Clears the last character entered.  
10  
Clear All: Clears the last selections made.  
11  
12  
Power Save: Sends the machine into Power Save mode or Power  
Down. Press the button again to restart a powered off machine.  
Power: Powers the machine on or off.  
13  
14  
Stop: Pressing the Stop button stops the job in progress. Pressing Stop  
also exits the Menu Mode. If you have logged in to use the machine,  
pressing Stop displays the Log Out option.  
Start: Activates a job.  
16  
19  
Manual Dial: In Fax mode, opens the fax line. In E-mail mode  
provides access to commonly used e-mail address text, for example,  
.com or .org. The text available can be customized using CentreWare  
Internet Services.  
Machine Status: Accesses machine information, status information,  
the machine serial number, and various reports to print.  
6
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Control Panel Overview  
Number  
Button  
Description  
20  
Status / Wireless LED: The color of the LEDs indicate the machine’s  
current status.  
21  
Fax: Activates Fax mode.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Powering On the Machine  
Powering On the Machine  
The power button is located on the control panel. The power cable socket is located at the rear of the  
printer.  
1. Connect the AC Power Cord to the machine and a power outlet. The power cord must be plugged  
into a grounded power socket.  
2. The WorkCentre 3215NI and 3225DNI will connect to a wireless network, if available, when  
powered on. Wi-Fi must be configured first. Refer to the Installation and Setup chapter for  
instructions.  
Note: The machine will not connect to the wireless network while the network cable is attached.  
3. Connect the network cable, if required.  
4. To allow faxing, connect the telephone line to the LINE Connector.  
5. Press the Power button on the control panel.  
Power Save  
This machine contains advanced energy conservation technology that reduces power consumption  
when it is not in active use. When the printer does not receive data for an extended period of time, the  
Power Save mode becomes active and power consumption is automatically lowered.  
To enter Power Save mode:  
1. Press the Power Save button.  
2. Use the Up/Down arrow buttons to select Power Save and then OK.  
8
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Powering On the Machine  
Powering Off the Machine  
There are two ways to power the machine off:  
Press the Power button.  
Press the Power Save button, and use the Up/Down arrows to select Power Down and then OK.  
Using the Keypad  
As you perform various tasks, you may need to enter names and numbers. For example, when you set  
up your machine, you enter your name or your company’s name, and the fax number. When you store  
fax numbers or e-mail addresses in memory, you may also enter the corresponding names.  
1. When you are prompted to enter a letter, locate the button labeled with the character you want.  
Press the button until the correct letter appears on the display.  
For example, to enter the letter O, press 6, labeled with MNO.  
Each time you press 6, the display shows a different letter, M, N, O, m, n, o and finally 6.  
2. You can enter special characters, such as @ / . & + -. Refer to Keypad Characters.  
3. To enter additional letters, repeat step 1. If the next letter is  
printed on the same button wait 2 seconds between presses, or  
move the cursor by pressing the down arrow and then press the  
button again. The cursor will move to the right and the next  
letter will appear on the display.  
If you make a mistake while entering a number or name, press  
the up arrow to delete the last digit or character. Then enter  
the correct number or character.  
4. When you have finished entering all characters, press OK.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Powering On the Machine  
Keypad Characters  
Key  
Assigned Numbers, Letters, or Characters  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
*
@ / . ‘ 1  
A B C a b c 2  
D E F d e f 3  
G H I g h i 4  
J K L j k l 5  
M N O m n o 6  
P Q R S p q r s 7  
T U V t u v 8  
W X Y Z w x y z 9  
& + - , 0 _  
*
#
#
10  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Powering On the Machine  
Menu Overview  
The control panel provides access to various menus. These menus can be accessed by pressing the  
appropriate service button, e.g. Copy, Scan, Fax, or E-mail, and the Menu button. The menu options  
available are as follows:  
Machine  
Status Menu  
Copy Menu  
Scan Menu  
Fax Menu  
E-mail Menu  
Original Size  
Reduce/Enlarge  
2 Sided  
Lighten/Darken  
Original Type  
Collation  
Layout  
Adjust  
Background  
Suppression  
Scan To:  
Lighten/Darken  
Resolution  
Original Size  
Multi Send  
Delay Send  
Priority Send  
Send Forward  
Receive  
Original Size  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Output Color  
File Format  
Lighten/Darken  
E-mail  
Information  
Pages  
Feature  
PC  
WSD  
Default  
Print Setup  
Fax Setup  
System  
Setup  
Network  
Confirmation  
Forward  
Secure Receive  
Add Page  
Cancel Job  
Note: Some menu options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration and  
whether the machine is in the Ready state. Also, for some services such as fax, additional  
selections or setups may be required before the Menu options can be accessed.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Powering On the Machine  
Machine Status Menu  
The Machine Status button provides information about the machine and access to the machine  
setups. After your machine is installed, it is recommended that you change the settings for various  
feature options within the print environment to meet your preferences and needs. A password may be  
required to access and change these settings.  
The following table shows the available options for each menu item.  
Information  
Pages  
Feature  
Defaults  
Print Setup  
Fax Setup  
System Setup  
Configuration  
Demo Page  
Network  
Configuration  
Supplies  
Information  
Usage Counters  
Fax Received  
Fax Sent  
Scheduled Jobs  
Fax Confirmation  
Junk Fax  
Copy Defaults  
E-mail Defaults  
Fax Defaults  
Orientation  
2-Sided  
Copies  
Resolution  
Clear Text  
Line  
Termination  
Skip Blank  
Pages  
Enable/Disable  
Sending  
Receiving  
Machine Setup  
Paper Setup  
Sound/Volume  
Maintenance  
Manual TX/RX  
Emulation  
PCL Font  
PS Font  
EPSON Font  
Note: Some menu options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration and  
whether the machine is in the Ready state.  
12  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Powering On the Machine  
Network Menu  
You may set up the network using the machine's display screen. Before doing that, you must have the  
relevant information concerning the type of network protocols and computer system you use. A  
password may be required to access and change the Network Setups. See the Installation and Setup  
chapter of this guide for information on setting up the network.  
Access the Network menu with the Machine Status button. The following options are available on the  
Network menu:  
TCP/IP (IPv4)  
TCP/IP (IPv6)  
Ethernet  
802.1x  
Wi-Fi  
Protocol Manager  
Network Configuration  
Clear Settings  
Alternatively, you may set up the network using CentreWare Internet Services at Properties > Network  
Settings.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Software  
Software  
After you have set up your machine and connected it to your computer, you must install the printer  
and scanner software. The software required for Windows or Macintosh is supplied on the CD delivered  
with your machine, additional software can be downloaded from www.xerox.com. The following  
software is available:  
Operating  
System  
CD  
Contents  
Printer  
Software  
Windows  
Printer Driver: Use the printer driver to take full advantage of your  
printer’s features. PCL6, Postscript and XPS drivers are provided.  
MFP PC Fax: Use to fax directly from your PC.  
Scanner Driver: TWAIN and Windows Image Acquisition (WIA) drivers  
are available for scanning documents on your machine.  
Xerox Easy Document Creator: Used to adjust scan settings and start  
the scanning process directly from your computer. The preview window  
allows you to view the scan and make adjustments as necessary and  
preferred settings can be preserved as favorites and added to a  
pre-defined list.  
Xerox Easy Print Manager (EPM): Conveniently combines access to  
device settings, printing/scanning environments, settings/actions, Scan  
to PC, Fax to PC, and launching applications such as Xerox Scan  
Assistant and CentreWare Internet Services in one location.  
Note: Login is required to change Printer Settings.  
Wireless Setting Program: When installing the printer you can use the  
Wireless Setting program that was automatically installed with the  
printer driver to configure the wireless settings.  
SetIP program: A utility program allowing you to select a network  
interface and manually configure the addresses for use with the TCP/IP  
protocol.  
Printer  
Software  
Linux  
Printer Driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of your printer’s  
features.  
Scanner Driver: A SANE driver is available for scanning documents on  
your machine.  
Note: Linux software is available on www.xerox.com only.  
14  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Software  
Operating  
System  
CD  
Contents  
Printer  
Software  
Unix  
Printer Driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of your printer’s  
features.  
Note: Unix software is available at www.xerox.com only.  
Printer  
Software  
Macintosh  
Printer Driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of your printer’s  
features.  
Scanner Driver: A TWAIN driver is available for scanning documents on  
your machine.  
SetIP Program: A utility program allowing you to select a network  
interface and manually configure the addresses for use with the TCP/IP  
protocol.  
Scan and Fax Manager: This utility allows you to configure MFP PC Fax  
and Scan settings.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Pages  
Information Pages  
This option allows the user to print the following reports:  
Report  
Description  
Menu Map  
Prints the menu map, which shows the layout and current settings of the  
machine.  
Configuration  
This report provides information about your machine setup, including  
the serial number, IP Address, installed options and the software  
version.  
Demo Page  
The demo page is printed to check the quality of the print.  
Prints the supplies information page.  
Supplies Information  
Fax Sent  
This report shows information on the faxes you have recently sent.  
Note: The machine prints this report every 50 communications.  
Fax Received  
This report shows information on the faxes you have recently received.  
This is the report for an individual fax transmission.  
Fax Confirmation  
Scheduled Jobs  
This list shows the documents currently stored for delayed faxing along  
with the start time and type of each operation.  
Junk Fax  
This list shows the fax numbers specified as junk fax numbers. To add or  
delete numbers, access the Junk Fax Setup menu.  
Network Configuration  
This list shows information about your machine’s network connection  
and configuration.  
PCL Font  
Prints the PCL font list.  
Prints the PS font list.  
Prints the EPSON font list.  
PS Font  
EPSON Font  
Usage Counter  
This list shows the number of impressions made on the machine. The list  
includes:  
Total Impressions  
Black Impressions  
Maintenance Impressions  
Sheets  
2 Sided Sheets  
16  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Information Pages  
Printing reports  
Various reports can be printed to provide information about your machine.  
1. Select the Machine Status button on the control panel.  
2. Press the Up/Down arrows to scroll to the Information Pages menu and select OK.  
3. Press the Up/Down arrows until the report you require displays and select OK.  
4. Select OK to print the report.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Feature Defaults  
Feature Defaults  
Your machine provides default settings for Copy, E-mail, and Fax so that you can quickly and easily  
make selections for your job. The default selections can be changed by selecting the Machine Status  
button on the control panel and the down arrows to select Feature Defaults. A password may be  
required to access and change the System Setup settings.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
Copy Defaults  
The default selections for the Copy options can be set to those most frequently used. When you copy a  
document, the default settings are used unless they have been changed for the current job. Once the  
current job is complete the settings return to the default settings. A password may be required to  
access and change the default settings.  
Copy defaults you can set include:  
Original Size  
Reduce/Enlarge  
2 Sided  
Lighten/Darken  
Original Type  
Collation  
Layout  
Adjust Background Suppression  
E-mail Defaults  
The default selections for the e-mail options can be set to those most frequently used. When you  
e-mail a document, the default settings are used unless they have been changed for the current job.  
Once the current job is complete the settings return to the default settings. A password may be  
required to access and change the default settings.  
E-mail defaults you can set include:  
Original Size  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Output Color  
File Format  
Lighten/Darken  
E-mail Confirmation  
18  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Feature Defaults  
Fax Defaults  
Your machine provides you with various user-selectable options for setting up the fax system. You can  
change the default settings for your preferences and needs. Receiving and Sending settings can be  
customized. A password may be required to access and change the Fax Setup settings.  
Fax defaults you can set include:  
Lighten/Darken  
Resolution  
Original Size  
Multi Send  
Delay Send  
Priority Send  
Send Forward  
Receive Forward  
Secure Receive  
Add Page  
Cancel Job  
Configuration Report  
The Configuration Report lists printer information such as default settings, installed options, network  
settings including IP address, and font settings. Use the information on the configuration page to help  
you configure network settings for your printer, and to view page counts and system settings.  
Printing a Configuration Report  
1. At the printer control panel, press the Machine Status button.  
2. Press the Up/Down arrows to display Information Pages, then press OK.  
3. Press the Up/Down arrows to display Configuration Page, then press OK.  
4. Press OK.  
Note: IPv4 and IPv6 address information is located in the Network Setup section of the  
Configuration Report under TCP/IP.  
Xerox® CentreWare® Internet Services  
Xerox® CentreWare® Internet Services is the administration and configuration software installed on the  
embedded Web server in the printer. It allows you to configure and administer the printer from a Web  
browser.  
Xerox® CentreWare® Internet Services requires:  
A TCP/IP connection between the printer and the network in Windows, Macintosh, Unix, or Linux  
environments.  
TCP/IP and HTTP enabled in the printer.  
A network-connected computer with a Web browser that supports JavaScript.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Feature Defaults  
Accessing Xerox® CentreWare® Internet Services  
At your computer, open a Web browser, and in the address field, type the IP address of the printer, then  
press Enter or Return.  
20  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessing the Printer  
Accessing the Printer  
The system administrator can set access rights on the printer to ensure that unauthorized users cannot  
access the printer. If the system administrator configures authentication and authorization, users  
require a login and password to access some or all of the features of the printer. The administrator can  
also configure accounting to require an accounting code to access tracked features.  
Logging In  
Logging in is the process by which you identify yourself to the printer for authentication. If  
authentication is set, to access printer features, you log in with your user credentials.  
Logging In to Xerox® CentreWare® Internet Services  
When Administrator Mode is enabled, the Jobs, Address Book, Properties, and Support tabs are locked  
until you enter the administrator user name and password.  
To log in to Xerox® CentreWare® Internet Services as the administrator:  
1. At your computer, open a Web browser, and in the address field, type the IP address of the printer,  
then press Enter or Return.  
2. Click Login at the top of the window.  
3. Type the administrator user name.  
4. Type the password, then type the password again to verify.  
5. Click Status, Print, Address Book, Properties, or Support.  
Logging In at the Control Panel  
1. At the printer control panel, press the Machine Status button.  
2. Use the Up/Down arrow buttons to navigate to the Machine Status option you want and press  
OK.  
3. Enter your administrator password using the keypad.  
4. Press OK.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More Information  
More Information  
You can obtain more information about your printer from these sources:  
Resource  
Location  
Other printer documentation  
www.xerox.com/office/WC3215docs  
www.xerox.com/office/WC3225docs  
Technical support information for  
your printer, including online  
technical support and driver  
downloads  
www.xerox.com/office/WC3215support  
www.xerox.com/office/WC3225support  
Demo page  
The demo page is printed to check the quality of the print.  
Print from the control panel, or from Xerox® CentreWare® Internet  
Information pages  
Services, select Status > Print Information.  
Xerox® CentreWare® Internet  
Services documentation  
In Xerox® CentreWare® Internet Services, click Help.  
Order supplies for your printer  
www.xerox.com/office/WC3215supplies  
www.xerox.com/office/WC3225supplies  
Tools and information, including  
interactive tutorials, printing  
templates, helpful tips, and  
customized features to meet your  
individual needs  
www.xerox.com/office/businessresourcecenter  
Local sales and support center  
Printer registration  
www.xerox.com/office/worldcontacts  
www.xerox.com/office/register  
www.direct.xerox.com/  
Xerox® Direct online store  
Management Information Base  
(MIB)  
A MIB is a database of objects that can be accessed by a network  
management system.  
Xerox public MIBs are located at:  
http://origin-download.support.xerox.com/pub/drivers/MIBs/  
Customers can download the MIBs and use their SNMP tool to obtain  
the required information.  
Note: All information presented on the local UI display is also presented  
in the MIB and CentreWare Internet Services. This includes e-mail  
addresses, phone numbers, and passwords as they are being entered. If  
this presents a security concern, Xerox recommends enabling the  
SNMPv3 and the IP Filtering security feature in order to control remote  
access to the device.  
22  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Further Assistance  
Further Assistance  
For any additional help visit our customer Web site at www.xerox.com or contact the Xerox Support  
Center quoting the machine serial number.  
Xerox Support Center  
If a fault cannot be resolved by following the display instructions, check the Troubleshooting chapter of  
this guide for information. If the difficulty persists, contact the Xerox Support Center. The Xerox  
Support Center will want to know the nature of the problem, the machine serial number, the fault code  
(if any) plus the name and location of your company.  
The Machine Serial Number can be found on the Configuration Report under ‘Device Profile’. The serial  
number is also located on the data plate on the rear cover of the device.  
Documentation  
Most answers to your questions will be provided by this User Guide. Alternatively you can access  
www.xerox.com/support for additional support and for the following documents:  
Install Guide - contains information about installing the machine.  
Quick Use Guide - provides basic information on how to use the machine.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Further Assistance  
24  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation and Setup  
2
This chapter includes:  
Overview  
Installation Wizard  
CentreWare Internet Services  
Network Installation: TCP/IP  
Network Installation: Unix  
Printer Drivers  
Windows Drivers  
Macintosh Drivers  
Linux Drivers  
Unix Drivers  
Sharing Your Machine Locally  
Windows Printing  
Air Print  
Google Cloud Print  
Scan to PC Setup  
Fax Setup  
E-mail Setup  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Overview  
Overview  
This chapter identifies the key settings that you can customize to meet your requirements. Changing  
these settings is easy and will save you time when using the machine.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
26  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installation Wizard  
Installation Wizard  
1. On initial power on the Installation Wizard runs, the Language menu displays.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select the required language and press OK.  
3. The Format Date menu displays. Press the up/down arrows to select one of the following and  
press OK:  
MM/DD/YYYY  
DD/MM/YYYY  
YYYY/MM/DD  
4. The Set Date menu displays.  
a. Press the buttons on the keypad to enter the date or press the up/down arrows to increase or  
decrease the value shown on the screen.  
b. Press the up/down arrows to move from one section of the date to another.  
c. When you have entered the date press OK.  
5. The Format Time menu displays. Press the up/down arrows to select one of the following and  
press OK:  
12 Hour  
24 Hour  
6. The Set Time menu displays. Press the buttons on the control panel to enter the time and press  
OK.  
7. The Metric Defaults menu displays. Press the up/down arrows to select one of the following and  
press OK:  
Inches  
mm  
8. The Default Paper Size menu displays. Press the up/down arrows to select one of the following  
and press OK:  
Letter  
A4  
9. The Allow Upgrade menu displays. Select Yes or No and press OK.  
10. The Admin Passcode menu displays. Select Yes or No and press OK. If you select Yes, enter a  
value on the SetAdminPasscode menu and CfmAdminPasscode menu.  
11. The Customer Support menu displays.  
a. Press the up/down arrows to select Enter Cust. Support #.  
b. The Enter Cust. Support # screen displays. Enter the telephone number of your customer  
support center.  
c. Press OK.  
d. The Enter Supplies Order # screen displays.  
e. Enter the telephone number to order supplies.  
f. Press OK. The Fax Setup menu displays.  
g. Press the up/down arrows to select one of the following and press OK:  
Continue Setup  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installation Wizard  
Skip Setup - go to step 15  
12. The Fax Phone Num menu displays. Enter the fax number of the machine and press OK.  
13. The Fax ID menu displays. Enter the fax id of the machine and press OK.  
14. The Country menu displays. Press the up/down arrows to select the required country and press  
OK.  
15. The Complete Set Up menu displays. Press the up/down arrows to select Yes or No and press OK.  
16. The machine reboots and the Initializing screen displays.  
Administrator Access  
Certain features accessed at the machine may require Administrator access to change the settings.  
Access to the Feature Defaults, System Setup and Network Settings areas are usually password  
protected.  
1. Press the Machine Status button on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select the required option.  
3. Press OK.  
4. If required, enter the Administrator Password using the alphanumerical keypad. The default is  
1111.  
5. Press OK. Once the password is verified, the selected option menu displays.  
Wireless Connectivity (WorkCentre 3215NI and 3225DNI)  
The WorkCentre 3215NI and WorkCentre 3225 DNI are compatible with 802.11 (Wi-Fi®) wireless  
networks. The location where the machine is installed must be covered by an 802.11 wireless network.  
This is typically provided by a nearby wireless access point or router, which is physically connected to  
the wired Ethernet that serves the building.  
The machine supports connectivity via a wireless only connection if required. The machine will  
automatically configure wireless networking when powered on.  
Note The machine will not connect to the wireless network while the network cable is attached.  
There are several ways to configure Wireless Connectivity:  
At the machine. For instructions refer to Configure Wireless Connectivity at the Machine.  
Using CentreWare Internet Services. For instructions refer to Configure Wireless  
Connectivity Using CentreWare Internet Services.  
With the Wireless Setting Program. For instructions refer to Wireless Setting Program.  
Note: Performing the driver installation at this time may aid wireless setup. Refer to Printer Drivers.  
Configure Wireless Connectivity at the Machine  
1. Press the Machine Status button.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select Network and press OK.  
3. Enter the Administrator Password using the alphanumerical keypad. The default is 1111.  
28  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Installation Wizard  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Wi-Fi and press OK. This allows you to select the Wi-Fi setup.  
The options are:  
Wi-Fi On/Off - allows you to turn Wi-Fi On or Off.  
Wi-Fi Settings - allows you to use a Wizard to find the wireless network name automatically,  
or use the Custom feature to enter the SSID (Service Set Identifier) information manually.  
WPS - allows you to select the Wi-Fi Protected Setup - the options are PBC or PIN.  
Wi-Fi Direct - allows you to enable your wireless devices, such as notebooks, mobile phones  
and PCs to establish wireless connectivity without the need for a wireless router, access point,  
or Wi-Fi hot spots.  
Wi-Fi Signal - allows you view the strength of the wireless connection.  
Wi-Fi Default - allows you to restore the default wireless settings.  
5. At the Wi-Fi On/Off menu, confirm that On is selected and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrows to select Wi-Fi Settings and press OK. The options are Wizard and  
Custom:  
a. Select Wizard - to have the machine find the WPS Settings automatically. If you select this,  
the Searching Wi-Fi Network screen displays and the machine searches the wireless network.  
Select your wireless network and select OK.  
Enter the wireless security information if requested and select OK.  
Select Yes to apply the changes.  
b. Select Custom - to edit the SSID information manually. If you select this option, the SSID  
screen displays.  
Enter the SSID using the keypad and select OK.  
Select the Operation Mode and select OK.  
Select the Encryption and select OK.  
Select the WPA Key and select OK.  
Select Yes to apply the changes.  
7. At the WPS menu, select PBC or PIN.  
8. At the Wi-Fi Direct menu, select On or Off, Device Name, IP Address, Group Owner, Network  
Key, and Status.  
9. At the Wi-Fi Signal menu, check to see if there is a Wi-Fi signal.  
10. At the Wi-Fi Default menu, select Restore if you want to restore defaults.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Wizard  
Configure Ethernet Settings  
The Ethernet interface will automatically detect the speed of your network. The machine supports  
hub/switch speeds of:  
Automatic  
10 Mbps Full-Duplex  
100 Mbps Full-Duplex  
10 Mbps Half-Duplex  
100 Mbps Half-Duplex  
Set the Ethernet speed on the machine to match the speed set on your hub or switch.  
Setting the Ethernet Speed at the Machine  
1. Press the Machine Status button.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select Network and press OK.  
3. Enter the Administrator Password using the alphanumerical keypad. The default is 1111.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Ethernet and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select Ethernet Speed and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrows to select one of the following speeds:  
Automatic  
10 Mbps Half  
10 Mbps Full  
100 Mbps Half  
100 Mbps Full  
7. Press OK. The Saved screen displays.  
To set the Ethernet Speed using CentreWare Internet Services, refer to Setting the Ethernet Speed  
Using CentreWare Internet Services.  
Configuration Report  
The Configuration Report details the machine software versions and network settings configured for  
the machine.  
Print a Configuration Report at the Machine  
1. Press the Machine Status button.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select Information Pages and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Configuration Page and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Yes and press OK. The Printing screen displays and the  
configuration report prints.  
30  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CentreWare® Internet Services  
CentreWare® Internet Services  
CentreWare Internet Services (Internet Services) is the embedded HTTP server application that resides  
in the machine. CentreWare Internet Services allows an administrator to change network and system  
settings on the machine from the convenience of their workstation.  
Many features available on your machine will need to be set via the machine and CentreWare Internet  
Services.  
System Configuration  
To use CentreWare Internet Services, you need to enable both TCP/IP and HTTP on the machine. See  
Configure Static IPv4 Addressing using the Machine User Interface, or Configure Dynamic IPv4  
Addressing using the Machine User Interface.  
To enable HTTP at the machine:  
Note HTTP is enabled by default.  
1. Press the Machine Status button.  
2. Use the up/down arrows to select Network.  
3. Use the up/down arrows to select Protocol Mgr.  
4. Use the up/down arrows to select HTTP.  
5. Select On.  
6. Press OK. The Saved screen will appear and then the Reboot Required screen will appear.  
Administrator User Name and Password  
Many of the features available within CentreWare Internet Services will require an Administrator user  
name and password. The default user name is admin and the default password is 1111.  
CentreWare Internet Services Administrator Access  
To access CentreWare Internet Services Properties and change settings you will need to log in as  
Administrator.  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter. The Home page appears.  
There are two ways to access CentreWare Internet Services with the administrator login:  
Select Login at the top of the screen or  
Select the Properties icon. You are then prompted for the ID and Password.  
3. Enter the admin for the ID and 1111 for the Password.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
CentreWare® Internet Services  
Change the Administrator Password  
It is recommended that you change the default administrator password to a more secure password, so  
this Xerox machine is not compromised.  
To change the Administrator password:  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select the Properties icon.  
4. If prompted, enter the admin for the ID and 1111 for the Password, and select Login. Select  
Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select System Security.  
6. Select the System Administrator link.  
7. In the Access Control area:  
a. Ensure Web UI Access Control Enable check box is selected.  
b. In the Login ID field, enter a new login name.  
c. Select the Change password box to change the password. In the Password field, enter a new  
numeric password.  
d. Enter the password again in the Confirm Password field.  
CAUTION: Do not forget the password or you could be completely locked out of the system,  
requiring a service call.  
8. Select Apply to save the changes.  
9. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
10. Select the Advanced button. The Advanced Access Control screen appears.  
11. Select Protect Login IPv4 Address to enable this feature if required, and enter an IPv4 Address in  
the box.  
12. Select the required option for the Login Failure Policy, for users who fail to login several times. The  
options are: Off, 3 times or 5 times.  
13. Select the required option for Auto Logout. The options are 5, 10, 15 or 30 minutes.  
14. Select Security Settings Reset if required.  
15. Select Save to save your changes.  
Configuring Wireless Connectivity Using CentreWare Internet Services  
(WorkCentre 3215NI and 3225DNI)  
Note The machine will not connect to the wireless network while the network cable is attached.  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
32  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CentreWare® Internet Services  
4. If prompted, enter the admin for the ID and 1111 for the Password, and select Login. Select  
Properties.  
5. In the Network Settings link, select the Wi-Fi link. Then select the Wi-Fi link below that.  
6. The Connection Status shows the Link Status of the wireless connection.  
7. The Wireless Settings area provides options to configure wireless connectivity. The options are  
Easy Wireless Settings and Advanced Settings, and are explained below.  
Use the Easy Wireless Settings Wizard  
1. Select the Easy Wi-Fi Settings Wizard button to have the machine find the WPS Settings  
automatically. The SSID screen appears with a list of available wireless networks.  
2. Select the required Network Name SSID and select Next.  
3. If encryption is required:  
a. Enter the WPA Shared Key.  
b. Enter the Confirm Network Key and select Next.  
4. The Wireless Setup Confirmation screen displays. Select Apply.  
Configure Advanced Wireless Settings  
1. Select the Advanced Settings Custom button. The Advanced Wireless Setup screen appears.  
2. To enable Wireless Radio, select On from the Wireless Radio menu.  
3. Select the required option for SSID:  
Select Search List and select the required network from the drop-down menu. Select the  
Refresh button to update the list of networks available.  
Select Insert New SSID to enter a new wireless network name.  
4. In the Security Setup area:  
a. Select the required method of Authentication.  
b. Select the required method of Encryption.  
5. Depending on your selections you may be required to enter some or all of the following  
information for the Network Key Setup.  
a. Select the required option for Using Key.  
b. The Hexadecimal option may be enabled. Select the Hexadecimal check box to deselect if  
required.  
c. Enter the required Network Key and Confirm Network Key.  
6. Depending on your selections you may be required to enter 802.1x Security Setup information.  
7. Select Apply to save the changes.  
Configuring Wi-Fi DirectTM at the machine  
Refer to Configure Wireless Connectivity at the Machine.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CentreWare® Internet Services  
Configuring Wi-Fi DirectTM using CentreWare Internet Services  
Wi-Fi DirectTM allows you to enable your wireless devices, such as notebooks, mobile phones and PCs to  
establish wireless connectivity without the need for a wireless router, access point, or Wi-Fi hot spots.  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the admin for the ID and 1111 for the Password, and select Login. Select  
Properties.  
5. In the Network Settings link, select the Wi-Fi link. Then select the Wi-Fi DirectTM link below that.  
6. Select On for Wi-Fi DirectTM.  
7. Enter the following:  
Device Name  
IP Address  
Activate or Deactivate the Group Owner  
Network Key  
8. Select Apply and then OK.  
Setting the Ethernet Speed Using CentreWare Internet Services  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Network Settings link select the General link.  
6. Select one of the following speeds from the Ethernet Speed drop-down menu:  
Automatic  
10 Mbps (Half Duplex)  
10 Mbps (Full Duplex)  
100 Mbps (Half Duplex)  
100 Mbps (Full Duplex)  
7. Select on Apply to save the changes.  
The change to Ethernet Speed rate will take effect after System Reboot screen appears.  
8. Select OK.  
9. When the Acknowledgement screen displays, select OK.  
10. Reboot the machine.  
34  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CentreWare® Internet Services  
Adjusting the Altitude  
Print quality is affected by atmospheric pressure, which is determined by the height of the machine  
above sea level. The following information will guide you on how to set your machine for the best print  
quality.  
Before you set the altitude value, determine the altitude where you are.  
Altitude  
Value  
0 - 1000 M  
0 - 3,280 ft.  
Normal  
1000 - 2000 M  
3,280 - 6,561 ft.  
High 1  
High 2  
High 3  
High 4  
2000 - 3000 M  
6,561 - 9,842 ft.  
3000 - 4000 M  
9,842 - 13,123 ft.  
4000 - 5000 M  
13,123 - 16,404 ft.  
1. Enter the IP Address of the printer in the browser.  
2. Select Login and enter the ID (admin) and Password (1111).  
3. Select Properties > System > Setup.  
4. Select an Altitude Adjustment value, based on your altitude in the table above.  
5. Select Apply.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CentreWare® Internet Services  
Setting the Toner Low Alert  
If the amount of toner in the cartridge is low, a ‘Low toner warning’ message displays on the Display  
Screen.  
1. Enter the IP Address of the printer in the browser.  
2. Select Login and enter the ID (admin) and Password (1111).  
3. Select Properties > System > Setup.  
4. Set the Toner Low Alert to On.  
5. Enter a percentage for the Toner Low Alert Level from 1 - 50%.  
6. Select Apply.  
Setting E-mail Notifications for Low Toner  
1. Enter the IP Address of the printer in the browser.  
2. Select Login and enter the ID (admin) and Password (1111).  
3. Select Machine Settings > E-mail Notification.  
4. Select Enable for E-mail Notification.  
5. Select Add.  
6. Enter a recipient Name and E-mail Address(es).  
7. Select Setting for Consumables.  
8. Under Consumable Shortage Warning, select a Toner Level percentage.  
9. Select Enable for Toner Empty, if required.  
10. Select a Drum Level percentage for notifications.  
11. Select Apply.  
36  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Installation: TCP/IP  
Network Installation: TCP/IP  
This section covers the following topics:  
TCP/IP  
These instructions show you how to configure the following via CentreWare Internet Services:  
TCP/IP v4 and v6  
Domain Name  
DNS  
Zero Configuration Networking  
The machine supports TCP/IP versions 4 and 6. IPv6 can be used instead of or in addition to IPv4.  
IPv4 and IPv6 settings can be configured directly at the machine user interface, or remotely, via a web  
browser using CentreWare Internet Services. To configure TCP/IP settings using CentreWare Internet  
Services, refer to Configure TCP/IP Settings using CentreWare Internet Services.  
Configure Static IPv4 Addressing at the Machine  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
Existing operational network utilizing the TCP/IP protocol.  
Ensure that the machine is connected to the network.  
Static IP Address for the machine.  
Subnet Mask Address for the machine.  
Gateway Address for the machine.  
Host Name for the machine.  
Procedure  
Enter a Static IP Address:  
1. Press the Machine Status button on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select Network and press OK.  
3. Enter the Administrator Password using the alphanumerical keypad. The default is 1111.  
4. Press the OK button; the Network Settings menu displays.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select TCP/IP(IPv4); press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrows to select Static; press OK.  
7. Press the up/down arrows to select IPv4 Address; press OK.  
8. Enter the IP Address using the alphanumerical keypad; press OK.  
9. Enter details for Subnet Mask using the alphanumerical keypad; press OK.  
10. Enter details for Gateway using the alphanumerical keypad; press OK.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Network Installation: TCP/IP  
11. The Saved screen will display and return to the Network menu.  
DNS Configuration:  
12. From the Network menu, press the up/down arrows to select TCP/IP(IPv4); press OK.  
13. Press the up/down arrows to select Static; press OK.  
14. Press the up/down arrows to select Primary DNS; press OK.  
15. Enter details for Primary DNS using the alphanumerical keypad; press OK. The Saved screen will  
display and return to the Static menu.  
16. Press the up/down arrows to select Secondary DNS; press OK.  
17. Enter details for Secondary DNS using the alphanumerical keypad; press OK. The Saved screen  
will display and return to the Network menu.  
Configure Dynamic IPv4 Addressing at the Machine  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
Existing operational network utilizing the TCP/IP protocol.  
DHCP or BOOTP Server should be available on the network.  
Ensure that the machine is connected to the network.  
Procedure  
Installation via DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)  
DHCP is enabled on the machine by default. If the machine is connected to the network, the TCP/IP  
information will be configured when the machine is powered on and no further configuration is  
required.  
Print a Configuration Report to verify that the information was assigned correctly.  
Installation via BOOTP or DHCP  
Ensure your machine is connected to the network with Ethernet cabling.  
1. Press the Machine Status button on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select Network Settings; press OK.  
3. Enter the Administrator Password using the alphanumerical keypad. The default is 1111.  
4. Press the OK button, the Network Settings menu displays.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select TCP/IP(IPv4); press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrows to select DHCP; press OK.  
7. The Saved screen will display and return to the Network Settings menu.  
38  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Installation: TCP/IP  
Configure TCP/IP Settings Using CentreWare Internet Services  
IPv4  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Network Settings link select TCP/IPv4 from the directory tree. The TCP/IPv4 page displays.  
6. In the Assign IPv4 Address menu, select Automatically or Manually.  
7. If Manually is selected, in the TCP/IP Settings area enter details of the machine in the following  
fields:  
a. IPv4 Address  
b. Subnet Mask  
c. Gateway Address  
If Automatically is selected, select BOOTP or DHCP.  
Notes:  
If BOOTP or DHCP mode is selected, you cannot change the IP Address, Network Mask,  
or Router/Gateway Address. Select Auto IP if required.  
New settings will not be applied until the machine is rebooted. Changing the machine’s  
TCP/IP setting may cause you to lose your connection to the machine.  
8. In the Domain Name area:  
a. Enter a domain name in the Domain Name field.  
b. Enter an IP address in the Primary DNS Server and Secondary DNS Server fields.  
c. Select the Enable box to enable Dynamic DNS Registration if required.  
Note: If your DNS Server does not support dynamic updates there is no need to select Enabled.  
9. In the WINS area select the box to enable WINS and enter details in the following fields:  
a. Primary WINS Server  
b. Secondary WINS Server  
10. Select Apply to save the changes.  
11. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
IPv6  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Installation: TCP/IP  
5. In the Network Settings link, select TCP/IPv6 from the directory tree.  
6. Select the Enable check box to enable IPv6 protocol and select OK.  
7. To set a manual address, select Enable Manual Address and enter the address and prefix in the  
Address/Prefix area. Information in the Assigned IPv6 Addresses box is automatically  
populated.  
8. The machine performs auto-address DHCPv6 configuration every time it powers up. This is used  
for neighbor discovery and address resolution on the local IPv6 subnet. However, you can choose  
to use manual configuration, automatic configuration, or a combination of automatic and  
manual configuration.  
In the Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol Version 6 (DHCPv6) area, select one of the  
following options:  
Use DHCP as directed by a router - this option is fully automatic. The DHCPv6 Address will  
be obtained and displayed on the screen.  
Always Enable DHCP - this option is fully automatic. The DHCPv6 Address will be obtained  
and displayed on the screen.  
Never use DHCP - when this option is selected, you must configure the Manual Address  
Options and DNS separately.  
9. In the Domain Name System Version 6 (DNSv6) area:  
a. Enter valid details in the IPv6 Domain Name field.  
b. Enter an IP addresses for the Primary DNSv6 Server Address and Secondary DNSv6 Server  
Address.  
c. Check the Dynamic DNSv6 Registration check box to enable this option.  
Note: If your DNS Server does not support dynamic updates there is no need to enable DDNS.  
10. Select Apply to save the changes.  
11. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Note: Enabling or disabling the TCP/IPv6 protocol will take effect after the system is rebooted.  
Enabling or disabling TCP/IPv6 will impact other protocols, for example, LPR/LPD, SNMP, Raw  
TCP/IP Printing, and DHCPv6 over TCP/IPv6.  
Test Access  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the TCP/IP Address of the machine in the  
Address bar. Press Enter.  
If you use the domain name to specify the machine, use the following format.  
http://myhost.example.com  
If you use the IP address to specify the machine, use one of the following formats depending on  
your machine configuration. An IPv6 address needs to be enclosed in square brackets.  
IPv4: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx  
IPv6: http://[xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx]  
Note: If you have changed the port number from the default port number 80, append the number  
to the Internet address as follows. In the following examples, the port number is 8080.  
Domain name: http://myhost.example.com:8080  
IPv4: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx:8080  
40  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Installation: TCP/IP  
IPv6: http://[xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx]:8080  
2. Verify that the home page of CentreWare Internet Services is displayed.  
The CentreWare Internet Services installation process is now completed.  
Note: When your access to CentreWare Internet Services is encrypted, enter https:// followed by  
the Internet address, instead of http://.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Installation: Unix  
Network Installation: Unix  
HP-UX Client (Version 10.x)  
HP-UX workstations require specific installation steps to communicate with the machine. The machine  
is a BSD-style Unix printer, whereas HP-UX is a System V-style Unix.  
IMPORTANT: All Unix commands are case sensitive, so enter the commands exactly as they are  
written.  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
Existing operational network utilizing the TCP/IP protocol.  
Ensure that the machine is connected to the network.  
Static IP Address for the machine.  
Subnet Mask Address for the machine.  
Gateway Address for the machine.  
Host Name for the machine.  
Procedure  
1. Follow the steps in Configure Static IPv4 Addressing at the Machine, then return to this page.  
Configure the Client  
2. Add the machine Host Name to the etc/hosts file on the HP-UX workstation.  
3. Ensure that you can ping the machine from the HP-UX workstation.  
4. Use either the GUI method or the tty methods as detailed below.  
GUI Method  
1. Open a Command window from the desktop.  
2. Enter su to access Super User mode.  
3. Enter sam to start the System Administrator Manager (SAM).  
4. Select the Printers and Plotters icon.  
5. Select lp spooler.  
6. Select Printers and Plotters.  
7. Select Actions: Add Remote Printer/Plotter.  
8. Enter the following information into the Add Remote Printer/Plotter form:  
a. Printer Name: printer name.  
Where printer name is the name of the queue being created.  
b. Remote System Name: hostname.  
Where hostname is the machine hostname from the /etc/hosts file.  
c. Select Remote Printer is on a BSD System.  
42  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Network Installation: Unix  
d. Select OK to complete the form.  
9. Select Yes at the Configure HP UX Printers Subpanel screen. This screen may be obscured by the  
Add Remote Printer/Plotter form.  
10. Select File: Exit.  
11. Select File: Exit Sam.  
12. Enter Exit to exit Super User mode.  
13. Test the queue created, by entering the command:  
lp -d queuename /etc/hosts  
14. Verify that the job prints at the machine.  
tty Method  
1. Enter su to access Super User mode.  
2. Enter sh to run the Bourne shell.  
3. Enter lpshut to stop the print service.  
4. Create the print queue by typing (on the same command line):  
lpadmin -pqueuename> -v/dev/null -mrmodel -ocmrcmodel -osmrsmodel -ob3 -orc  
-ormhostname -orplp  
Where queuename is the name of the queue being created and hostname is the machine  
hostname.  
5. Enter lpsched to start the print service.  
6. Enter enable queuename to enable the queue to print to the machine.  
7. Enter accept queuename to the queue accepting jobs from the HP-UX workstation.  
8. Enter Exit to exit the Bourne shell.  
9. Enter Exit to exit Super User mode.  
10. Test the queue created, by entering the command:  
lp -d queuename /etc/hosts  
11. Verify that the job prints at the machine.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Installation: Unix  
Solaris 9 and later  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
Existing operational network utilizing the TCP/IP protocol.  
Ensure that the machine is connected to the network.  
Static IP Address for the machine.  
Subnet Mask Address for the machine.  
Gateway Address for the machine.  
Host Name for the machine.  
Procedure  
Follow the steps in Configure Static IPv4 Addressing at the Machine, then return to this page.  
Configure the Client  
1. Add the machine printer Host Name to the etc/hosts file.  
2. Ensure that you can ping the machine.  
3. Use either the GUI method or the tty method as detailed below.  
GUI Method  
1. Open a Command window from the desktop.  
2. Enter su to access Super User mode.  
3. Enter admintool to run the System Administrator Tool.  
4. Select Browse: Printers.  
5. Select Edit: Add: Access to Printer.  
6. Enter the following information into the Access to Remote Printer form:  
a. Printer Name: queuename  
Where queuename is the name of the queue being created.  
b. Print Server: hostname  
Where hostname is the machine hostname from the /etc/hosts file.  
c. Select OK to complete the form.  
7. Enter sh to run the Bourne shell.  
8. Enter the command: lpadmin -p queuename -s hostname !lp to modify the remote queuename  
9. Enter Exit to exit the Bourne shell.  
10. Enter Exit to exit Super User mode.  
11. Test the queue created, by entering the command:  
lp -d queuename /etc/hosts  
12. Verify that the job prints at the machine.  
44  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Installation: Unix  
tty Method  
1. Enter su to access Super User mode.  
2. Enter sh to run the Bourne shell.  
3. Define the machine as a BSD style printer, by entering the command:  
lpsystem -t bsd hostname  
Where hostname is the machine hostname from the /etc/hosts file.  
4. Create the queue, by entering the command:  
lpadmin -p queuename -s hostname -T unknown -I any  
where queuename is the name of the queue being created.  
5. Enter Exit to exit the Bourne shell.  
6. Enter Exit to exit Super User mode.  
7. Test the queue created, by entering the command:  
lp -d queuename /etc/hosts  
8. Verify that the job prints at the machine.  
SCO  
SCO Unix workstations require specific installation steps to communicate with the machine. The  
machines are BSD-style Unix printers, whereas SCO is a System V-style Unix.  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
Existing operational network utilizing the TCP/IP protocol.  
Ensure that the machine is connected to the network.  
Static IP Address for the machine.  
Subnet Mask Address for the machine.  
Gateway Address for the machine.  
Host Name for the machine.  
Procedure  
Follow the steps in Configure Static IPv4 Addressing at the Machine, then return to this page.  
Configure the Client  
1. Add the machine printer Host name to the etc/hosts file on the SCO workstation.  
2. Ensure that you can ping the machine from the SCO workstation.  
Perform the following steps to create a machine print queue on a SCO Unix workstation using  
either the GUI or the TTY method.  
GUI Method  
1. Log in as root.  
2. From the main desktop, select the icons System Administration: Printers: Printer Manager.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Installation: Unix  
3. Select Printer: Add Remote: Unix.  
4. Enter the following information into the Add Remote Unix Printer form:  
a. Host: hostname.  
Where hostname is the machine Host Name from the /etc/hosts file.  
b. Printer: name of the queue being created.  
For example: dc xxxq.  
c. Select OK to complete the form.  
5. Select OK in the Message window.  
6. Select Host:Exit.  
7. Select File: Close this directory.  
8. Select File: Close this directory.  
9. Select Save in the Warning Confirmation window.  
10. Enter Exit to log out of root account.  
11. Open Unix Window.  
tty Method  
1. Enter su to access Super User mode.  
2. Enter rlpconf to create a printer.  
3. Enter the following information:  
a. Printer Name: queuename  
b. Remote Printer: r  
c. Hostname: hostname  
d. If the information has been entered correctly, enter y  
4. Select Enter to accept the default for a non-SCO remote printer.  
5. Select Enter to accept the default for non-default printer.  
6. Select Enter to start the process for adding a queue.  
7. Enter q to quit the rlconf program.  
46  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Installation: Linux CUPS  
Network Installation: Linux CUPS  
Static Addressing  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following item is available and/or the task has been performed:  
Linux operating system that supports printtool.  
Procedure  
Follow the steps in Configure Static IPv4 Addressing at the Machine, then return to this page.  
Create the Print Queue  
1. Ensure that the Common Unix Printing System (CUPS) is installed and started on your client.  
The latest version of CUPS is available at cups.org.  
2. Open the web browser from your workstation.  
3. For example, enter http://127.0.0.1:631/printers in the Address Bar.  
4. Press Enter.  
5. Select Add Printer.  
6. The Authorization dialog box displays.  
7. Enter the root and the root password.  
8. In the Add New Printer screen enter a name for the printer.  
9. Enter a location and description for the printer (optional).  
10. Select Continue.  
11. In the Machine menu, select Internet Printing Protocol.  
12. Select Continue.  
13. Enter ipp://hostname/ipp/printername  
Where hostname is the hostname of the Xerox machine and printername is the printer name of  
the Xerox machine.  
14. Select Continue.  
15. Select Xerox in the Make menu.  
16. Select Continue.  
17. Select the correct driver in the Driver menu.  
18. Select Continue.  
19. The Printer Added Successfully message will appear.  
Dynamic Addressing  
Procedure  
Follow the steps in Configure Dynamic IPv4 Addressing at the Machine, then return to this page.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Installation: Linux CUPS  
Important: Select BOOTP in step 6.  
Create the Print Queue  
Follow the steps to Create the Print Queue.  
Linux LPR via PrintTool  
Static Addressing  
Information Checklist  
Before starting please ensure that the following item is available and/or the task has been performed:  
Linux operating system that supports PrintTool.  
Procedure  
1. Follow the steps in Configure Static IPv4 Addressing using the Machine User Interface, then return  
to this page.  
Create the Print Queue  
2. Log in, at the Linux Client, as root in a terminal.  
3. Enter printtool.  
4. The Red Hat Linux Print System Manager will launch.  
5. Select Add.  
6. The Add a Printer Entry window displays.  
7. Select Remote Unix (lpd) Queue.  
8. Select OK.  
9. The Edit Remote Unix (lpd) Queue Entry window displays.  
10. Enter the name of your Print Queue in the Names area.  
11. The Spool directory is the directory where print jobs are stored and is a subdirectory of  
/var/spool/lpd. Add the name of the print queue to the end of the subdirectory path.  
12. Ensure that the File Limit reads 0.  
13. In the Remote Host area, enter the IP Address of the Xerox machine.  
14. In the Remote Queue area, enter the Print Queue Name from step 10.  
15. Do not select the Input Filter option.  
16. Leave the default Suppress Headers selected.  
17. Select OK.  
18. The printer should now be listed in the Red Hat Linux Print System Manager window. Select the  
lpd menu.  
19. Select Restart lpd.  
20. Select the PrintTool menu.  
21. Select Exit to close the program.  
48  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Installation: Linux CUPS  
22. To allow access to the printer, edit the /etc/hosts table to list the client system.  
23. Edit and create the /etc/hosts.lpd file to list the client system.  
Dynamic Addressing  
Procedure  
Follow the steps in Configure Dynamic IPv4 Addressing at the Machine, then return to this page.  
Important: Highlight BOOTP in step 6.  
Create the Print Queue  
Follow the steps to Create the Print Queue.  
Linux LPRng  
Static Addressing  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following item is available and/or the task has been performed:  
Linux operating system that supports PrintTool.  
Procedure  
Follow the steps in Configure Static IPv4 Addressing using the Machine User Interface, then return to  
this page.  
Create the Print Queue  
1. Open the LPRngTool from the Linux Client.  
2. Select Add.  
3. In the Names area, enter a name for your print queue.  
4. The spool directory is the directory where print jobs are stored and is a subdirectory of  
/var/spool/lpd. Add the name of the print queue to the end of the subdirectory path.  
5. In the Hostname/IP of Printer area, enter the hostname or IP Address of the Xerox machine.  
6. Select OK.  
7. Select Exit to close the program.  
8. To allow access to the printer, edit the /etc/hosts table to list the client system.  
9. Edit and create the /etc/hosts.lpd file to list the client system.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Installation: Linux CUPS  
Dynamic Addressing  
Procedure  
Follow the steps in Configure Dynamic IPv4 Addressing using the Machine User Interface on page 29,  
then return to this page.  
Important: Highlight BOOTP in step 6.  
Follow the steps to Create the Print Queue.  
50  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printer Drivers  
Printer Drivers  
Overview  
The software and documentation CD is supplied with your machine.  
The machine supports the following operating systems:  
Platform  
Operating Systems  
Windows®  
Windows 7 & 8 (32/64 bit)  
Windows Vista (32/64 bit)  
Windows XP (32/64 bit)  
Windows 2003 Server (32/64 bit)  
Windows 2008 Server (32/64 bit)  
Windows 2008R2 (64 bit)  
Macintosh®  
Linux  
Macintosh OS X 10.5 - 10.9  
Ubuntu 10.04, 10.10, 11.04, 11.10, 12.04, 12.10,  
13.04  
Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5, 6  
Fedora 11 -19  
Debian 5.0, 6.0, 7.0, 7.1  
Mint 13, 14, 15  
SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10, 11  
openSUSE 11.0, 11.1, 11.2, 11.3, 11.4, 12.1, 12.2,  
12.3  
Unix®  
Oracle® Solaris 9, 10, 11 (x86, SPARC)  
HP-UX® 11i v1, 11i v2, 11i v3 (PA-RISC, Itanium)  
IBM® AIX 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 6.1, 7.1 (PowerPC)  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Windows Drivers  
Windows Drivers  
The Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225 produces high quality prints from electronic documents. You can  
access the printer from your computer by installing the appropriate printer driver. To access the many  
printer drivers which can be used with your machine, refer to the Drivers CD or download the latest  
Installing Windows Drivers  
The following provides an overview of the print procedure and features available when printing using  
Windows.  
Install Printer Software  
You can install the printer software for local printing and network printing. To install the printer  
software on the computer, perform the appropriate installation procedure depending on the printer in  
use.  
A printer driver is software that lets your computer communicate with your printer. The procedure to  
install drivers may differ depending on the operating system you are using. All applications should be  
closed on your PC before beginning installation.  
You can install the printer software for a local, networked or wireless printer using the recommended or  
custom method.  
Local Printer  
A local printer is a printer directly attached to your computer using a printer cable, such as a USB cable.  
If your printer is attached to a network, refer to Networked Printer.  
Note: If the New Hardware Wizard window appears during the installation procedure, select Close  
or Cancel.  
1. Make sure that the printer is connected to your computer and powered on.  
2. Insert the supplied CD-ROM into your CD-ROM drive. The CD-ROM should automatically run, and  
an installation window appears.  
If the installation window does not appear, select the Start button and then Run. Type  
X:\Setup.exe, replacing X with the letter which represents your drive and select OK.  
If you use Windows Vista, select Start > All programs > Accessories > Run, and type X:\Setup.exe.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, select Run Setup.exe in the Install or run  
program field, and select Continue in the User Account Control window.  
3. Select Install Software. A Printer Connection Type window displays.  
4. Select USB connection. The Select Software to Install window displays.  
5. Leave the default selections and select Next. The Installing Software window displays.  
6. After the installation is finished, the Setup Completed window displays.  
7. Select Print a test page and select Finish.  
52  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Windows Drivers  
If your printer is connected to the computer, a Test Print page will be printed. If the Test Print operation  
is successful, refer to the Print chapter of this guide. If the print operation failed, refer to the  
Troubleshooting chapter of this guide.  
Networked Printer  
When you connect your printer to a network, you must first configure the TCP/IP settings for the  
printer. After you have assigned and verified the TCP/IP settings, you are ready to install the software  
on each computer on the network.  
1. Make sure that the printer is connected to your network and powered on.  
2. Insert the supplied CD-ROM into your CD-ROM drive.  
The CD-ROM should automatically run, and an installation window appears.  
If the installation window does not appear, select the Start button and then Run. Type  
X:\Setup.exe, replacing X with the letter which represents your drive and select OK.  
If you use Windows Vista, select Start > All programs > Accessories > Run, and type X:\Setup.exe.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, select Run Setup.exe in Install or run program  
field, and select Continue in the User Account Control window.  
3. Select Install Software.  
4. Select Network connection and follow the wizard instruction to select and install the printer.  
Note: For custom install instructions, refer to Custom Installation.  
5. After the installation is finished, select Print a test page and select Finish.  
If your printer is connected to the network, a Test Print page will be printed. If the Test Print operation  
is successful, refer to the Print chapter of this guide. If the print operation failed, refer to the  
Troubleshooting chapter of this guide.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows Drivers  
Custom Installation  
With the custom installation, you can choose individual components to install.  
1. Make sure that the printer is connected to your computer and powered on.  
2. Insert the supplied CD-ROM into your CD-ROM drive.  
The CD-ROM should automatically run, and an installation window appears. If the installation  
window does not appear, select Start and then Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing X with the letter  
which represents your drive and select OK.  
If you use Windows Vista, select Start > All Programs > Accessories > Run, and type X:\Setup.exe.  
Note: If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, select Run Setup.exe in Install or run  
program field, and select Continue in the User Account Control window.  
3. Select Install Software.  
4. Select your connection type and select Next. The Select Software to Install window displays.  
5. Select Custom from the Setup type dropdown box.  
6. Select the components to be installed and select Next.  
Note: When you select an option, a description of that option displays at the bottom of the  
screen.  
7. Select Advanced Options if you would like to do any of the following:  
Change the printer name  
Change the default printer  
Share the printer with other users on the network  
Change the destination path where driver files and user guide files will be copied to. Select  
Browse to change the path.  
8. Select OK to continue, then select Next. The Copying Files window displays, and then the  
Installing Software window.  
9. After the installation is finished, the Setup Completed window displays.  
10. Select Print a test page and select Finish.  
If your printer is connected to the computer, a Test Print page will be printed. If the Test Print operation  
is successful, refer to the Print chapter of this guide. If the print operation failed, refer to the  
Troubleshooting chapter of this guide.  
Wireless Printer (WorkCentre 3215NI and WorkCentre 3225DNI)  
When you connect your printer to a network, you must first configure the TCP/IP settings for the  
printer. After you have assigned and verified the TCP/IP settings, you are ready to install the software  
on each computer on the network.  
1. Make sure that the printer is connected to your computer with a USB cable and powered on.  
2. Insert the supplied CD-ROM into your CD-ROM drive. The CD-ROM should automatically run, and  
an installation window appears.  
If the installation window does not appear, select the Start button and then Run. Type  
X:\Setup.exe, replacing X with the letter which represents your drive and select OK.  
54  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows Drivers  
If you use Windows Vista, select Start > All programs > Accessories > Run, and type X:\Setup.exe.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, select Run Setup.exe in Install or run program  
field, and select Continue in the User Account Control window.  
3. Select Install Software. A Printer Connection Type window displays.  
4. Select Wireless network connection.  
5. When asked if you are setting up the printer for the first time, select Yes, I will set up my printer’s  
wireless network and select Next.  
6. Select your wireless network from the list and select Next.  
7. Select Advanced Settings to set the following:  
8. Select Next.  
9. Follow the wizard instruction to select and install the printer. Select your connection type and  
select Next. The Select Software to Install window displays.  
10. After the installation is finished, the Setup Complete page will display. Select Print a test page  
and select Finish.  
If your printer is connected to the network, a Test Print page prints. If the Test Print operation is  
successful, refer to the Print chapter of this guide. If the print operation failed, refer to the  
Troubleshooting chapter of this guide.  
Wireless Setting Program  
When installing the WorkCentre 3215NI and WorkCentre 3225DNI, you can use the Xerox Easy  
Wireless Setup program that was automatically installed with the printer driver to configure the  
wireless settings.  
To open the program:  
1. Select Start > Programs or All Programs > Xerox Printers > [Xerox WorkCentre 3215 or 3225]>  
Xerox Easy Wireless Setup.  
2. Connect the machine to your computer using the USB cable.  
Note: During installation, the printer needs to be temporarily connected using the USB cable.  
Note: You cannot use your printer on a wired and wireless network at the same time. If your  
printer is currently connected to the network with an Ethernet cable, unplug the cable.  
3. Select Next.  
4. Once the machine is connected to the computer with the USB cable, the program searches for  
WLAN data.  
5. When the search is complete, the Select Wireless Network window displays. Select your network  
from the list.  
6. Select Advanced Setting if you want to enter the following information:  
7. Select Next. The Wireless Network Security screen displays.  
8. Enter your Network Password and select Next.  
9. When the Wireless Network Setup Complete page displays, select Finish.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Windows Drivers  
Uninstalling a Windows driver  
For Windows follow the steps below to uninstall the driver:  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on.  
2. From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Xerox Printers > Uninstall Xerox Printer  
Software. The Uninstall Xerox Printer Software window displays.  
3. Select Next. The Select Software window displays.  
4. Select the components you want to remove and then select Next and then Yes to confirm.  
5. When your computer asks you to confirm your selection, select Yes. The Uninstallation window  
displays.  
6. After the software is removed, select Finish.  
If you want to reinstall the driver over the currently installed driver via the provided software and  
documentation CD, insert the CD; the window with an overwriting confirmation message appears.  
Simply confirm it to proceed to the next step. Next steps are same as the first installation you  
performed.  
56  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Macintosh Drivers  
Macintosh Drivers  
The software and documentation CD that came with your machine provides you with the printer driver  
files that allow you to use the CUPS driver or PostScript driver (only available when you use a machine  
which supports the PostScript driver) for printing on a Macintosh computer.  
A TWAIN driver is also provided for scanning on a Macintosh computer.  
Information Checklist  
Before starting please ensure that the following item is available and/or the task has been performed:  
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on.  
Procedure  
These steps were performed using Macintosh version 10.8.5. Instructions may vary depending on your  
operating system version.  
1. Insert the supplied software and documentation CD into your CD-ROM drive.  
2. Select the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop.  
3. Select the MAC_Installer folder.  
4. Select the Installer icon.  
5. The Install window opens. Select Continue.  
6. Select Install.  
Standard Install is the default and is recommended for most users. All components necessary for  
machine operations are installed.  
If you select Customize, you can choose individual components to install.  
7. Enter your password and select Install Software.  
8. Select how the printer will be connected to your computer. Choices are:  
USB Connected Printer  
Network Connected Printer  
Configuration of Wireless Network  
9. Select Continue.  
10. Select Add Printer and select Continue and follow the instructions on the installation wizard.  
11. Select the options you want to add, such as Fax.  
12. Select the Add Easy Printer Manager to Dock option if required.  
13. After the installation is complete, select Close.  
14. Select the Applications folder > System Preferences > Print & Scan.  
15. Select the + sign on the Printer list and select the printer or enter the IP Address for the printer.  
16. Select Add.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Macintosh Drivers  
Uninstalling a Macintosh Driver  
If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and reinstall it. Follow the steps below to  
uninstall the driver for Macintosh.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on.  
2. Select the Applications folder.  
3. Select the Xerox folder.  
4. Select Printer Software Uninstaller.  
5. Select the programs you want to uninstall and select Uninstall.  
6. Enter your password.  
7. Select Close.  
58  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Linux Drivers  
Linux Drivers  
You need to download the Linux software package from the Xerox website to install the printer  
software.  
Procedure for Installing the Linux Unified Driver  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on.  
You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine software. If you are not a super user,  
ask your system administrator.  
2. When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the Login field and enter the  
system password.  
3. From the Xerox web site, download the Unified Linux Driver package to your computer.  
4. Select the Unified Linux Driver package and extract the package.  
5. Select cdroot > autorun.  
6. When the Welcome screen appears, select Next.  
7. When the installation is complete, select Finish.  
The installation program has added the Unified Driver Configuration desktop icon and the Unified  
Driver group to the system menu for your convenience. If you have any difficulties, consult the  
on-screen help that is available through your system menu or called from the driver package Windows  
applications, such as Unified Driver Configurator or Image Manager.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Unix Drivers  
Unix Drivers  
Unix printer drivers are located on the software and documentation CD delivered with your machine.  
To use the Unix printer driver, you need to install the Unix printer driver package first, then set up the  
printer. The installation procedure is common for all variants of Unix OS mentioned.  
Procedure for Installing the Unix Driver Package  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on.  
2. Acquire root privileges.  
su -  
3. Copy the appropriate driver archive to the target Unix computer.  
4. Unpack the Unix printer driver package name.  
For example, on IBM AIX, use the following command:  
gzip -d < package archive name | tar xf -  
The binaries folder consists of binz, install, share files and folders.  
5. Change to the driver’s binaries directory.  
For example, on IBM AIX,  
cd aix_power/binaries  
6. Run the install script.  
./install  
Install is the installer script file which is used to install or uninstall the Unix Printer Driver package.  
Use chmod 755 install command to give the permission to the installer script.  
7. Execute the ./install-c command to verify installation results.  
8. Run installprinter from the command line. This will bring up the Add Printer Wizard window.  
Follow the procedures in Setting up the printer.  
Note On some Unix OS, for example on Solaris 10, printers recently installed may not be enabled  
and/or may not accept jobs. In this case run the following two commands on the root terminal:  
accept <printer_name>  
enable <printer_name>  
Setting Up the Printer  
To add the printer to your Unix system, run installprinter from the command line. This will bring up the  
Add Printer Wizard window. Setup the printer in this window according to the following steps.  
1. Type the name of the printer.  
2. Select the appropriate printer model from the model list.  
3. Enter any description corresponding to the type of printer in the Type field. This is optional.  
4. Specify any printer description in the Description field. This is optional.  
5. Specify the printer location in the Location field.  
60  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Unix Drivers  
6. Type the IP address or DNS name of the printer in the Device text box for network connected  
printers. On IBM AIX with jetdirect Queue type, only the DNS name is possible. It is not possible  
to enter a numeric IP address.  
7. Queue type shows the connection as lpd or jetdirect in the corresponding list box. Additionally  
usb type is available on Sun Solaris OS.  
8. Select Copies to set the number of copies.  
9. Check the Collate option to receive copies already sorted.  
10. Check the Reverse Order option to receive copies in the reverse order.  
11. Check the Make Default option to set this printer as default.  
12. Select OK to add the printer.  
Uninstalling the Printer Driver Package  
Note The utility should be used if you need to delete a printer installed on the system.  
1. Run the uninstallprinter command from the terminal. The Uninstall Printer Wizard opens and the  
installed printers are n the drop-down list.  
2. Select the printer to be deleted.  
3. Select Delete to delete the printer from the system.  
4. Execute the ./install-d command to uninstall the whole package.  
5. To verify removal results, execute the ./install-c command.  
6. To re-install it, use the command ./install to reinstall the binaries.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sharing Your Machine Locally  
Sharing Your Machine Locally  
If a host computer is directly connected to the machine with a USB cable and is also connected to the  
local network environment, the client computer connected to the local network can use the shared  
machine through the host computer to print.  
Follow the steps below to set up the computers to share your machine locally.  
Windows  
Host Computer Setup  
1. Install your printer driver. Refer to Printer Drivers.  
2. Depending on your operating system, navigate to the Printers, Printers and Faxes, or Devices  
and Printers settings from the Windows Start menu or through the control panel.  
3. Select your printer icon and select Printer Properties.  
Note If the Printer properties item has a ?, you can select other printer drivers connected with the  
selected printer.  
4. Select the Sharing tab.  
5. Check the Change Sharing Options check box.  
6. Check the Share this printer check box.  
7. Enter details in the Share Name field.  
8. Select OK or Next.  
Client Computer Setup  
1. Install your printer driver. Refer to Printer Drivers.  
2. From the Windows Start menu select All programs > Accessories > Windows Explorer.  
3. Enter the IP address of the host computer and press Enter.  
4. If the host computer requires a User name and Password, enter details in the User ID and  
password field of the host computer account.  
5. Select the printer you want to share and select Connect.  
If a setup complete message appears, select OK.  
6. Open the file you want to print and start printing.  
62  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Sharing Your Machine Locally  
Macintosh  
The following steps are for Macintosh OS X 10.8.5. Refer to Macintosh Help for other OS versions.  
Host Computer Setup  
1. Install your printer driver. Refer to Installing Macintosh driver.  
2. Open the Applications folder, select System Preferences.  
3. Select Print & Fax or Print & Scan.  
4. Select the printer to share in the Printers list.  
5. Select Share this printer.  
Client Computer Setup  
1. Install your printer driver. Refer to Installing Macintosh driver.  
2. Open the Applications folder, select System Preferences.  
3. Select Print & Fax or Print & Scan.  
4. Select Add or the + symbol.  
A display window showing the name of your shared printer displays.  
5. Select your machine and select Add.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Windows Printing  
Windows Printing  
LPR Printing  
Ensure Print Services for Unix is Enabled  
Follow the relevant steps below that are specific to your operating system:  
Windows 2003  
1. From the desktop, select the My Network Places icon and select Properties.  
2. Select the Local Area Connection icon and select Properties.  
3. Verify that the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) protocol has been loaded. If this software is not present,  
install it using the documentation provided by Microsoft. When you are finished, return to this  
page.  
4. Verify that Print Services for Unix is loaded:  
a. Select Start > Settings > Control Panel.  
b. Select the Add/Remove Programs icon.  
c. Select Add/Remove Win Components in the far left column.  
d. Select Other Network File > Print Services.  
e. Select Details.  
f. Check the Print Services for Unix check box. If Print Services for Unix is not installed, refer to  
instructions from Microsoft to install this service. When you are finished, return to this page.  
5. Select the OK button.  
6. Select the Next button.  
7. Select the Finish button.  
8. Close the Add/Remove Programs window.  
Windows Vista  
1. Select Start > Control Panel > Program and select Programs and Features.  
2. Select Turn Windows Features on and off.  
3. In the Windows Features window, expand the Print Services menu.  
4. Check the LPR Port Monitor check box to enable the service.  
5. Select the OK button. Your computer may need to restart.  
Windows 7  
1. Select Start, select Control Panel.  
2. Select Hardware and Sound > Programs.  
3. Select Programs and Features.  
4. Select Turn Windows Features on and off from the menu on the left.  
5. A Windows Features dialog displays. Select the + sign for Print and Document Services.  
64  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Windows Printing  
6. Check the box for LPR Port Monitor to enable the service.  
7. Select the OK button. Your computer may need to restart.  
Windows 2008  
1. Select Start > Administrative Tools.  
2. Select Print Management.  
3. Select the + sign for Print Servers. Select the print server to which you want to add the printer and  
select Add Printer.  
4. Select the check box for LPR Port Monitor to enable the service.  
5. Select the OK button. Your computer may need to restart.  
Install Printer Driver  
1. From the Windows Start menu, navigate to your Devices and Printers or Printers settings.  
2. Select Add a Printer.  
3. Select the Local Printer option.  
Depending on your operating system, if already selected, select Automatically detect and install  
my Plug and Play printer to deselect it.  
4. Select the local printer and select Next.  
5. Select Create a new port.  
6. Select the LPR option from the Type of Port pull-down menu:  
7. Select the Next button.  
8. Enter the IP Address of the printer.  
9. Enter a name for the printer.  
10. Select the OK button.  
11. You will be prompted for a Printer Driver. Select Have Disk.  
12. Select the Browse button.  
13. Select the required Printer Driver file .inf.  
14. Select the Open button.  
15. Select the OK button.  
16. Select the printer model from the list.  
17. Select the Next button.  
18. The Name your Printer screen appears.  
19. Enter details in the Printer name field.  
20. Select the Next button. The Printer Sharing screen appears.  
21. Select the Do not share or Share option and enter the name, location, and comment, if required.  
22. Select the Next button.  
23. Select Set as the default printer if required.  
24. Select Print Test Page to print a test page.  
25. Select the Finish button. The printer driver will install.  
26. Verify that the test page is printed at the machine.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows Printing  
Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) Port  
The Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) defines a standard protocol for printing as well as managing print  
jobs, media size, resolution, and so forth. IPP can be used locally or over the Internet, and also supports  
access control, authentication, and encryption, making it a much more capable and secure printing  
solution than older ones.  
Note IPP Printing is enabled by default.  
How to Enable the IPP Port  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Select Properties.  
3. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
4. In the Network Settings link select Raw TCP/IP, LPR, IPP in the directory tree.  
5. In the Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) area:  
a. For IPP Protocol, select Enable from the drop-down menu. The Printer URL displays the  
http:// IP address of the machine and the ipp:// IP address of the machine. Enter the required  
printer name in the Printer Name area.  
b. Select the Advanced button. Enter the required information for IPP Attribute.  
Install Printer Driver  
1. Follow the steps below that are specific to your operating system:  
Windows 2003  
From your workstation:  
a. Select the My Network Places icon.  
b. Select Properties.  
Windows 7  
From your workstation:  
a. Select Control Panel.  
b. Select Network and Internet.  
c. Select Network and Sharing Center.  
d. Select Change adapter settings.  
Windows 2008  
From your workstation:  
a. Select Start, select Control Panel.  
b. Select Printers.  
c. Select File, select Run as administrator. Go to step 6.  
2. Select the Local Area Connection icon.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. Ensure that the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) protocol has been loaded and ensure the check box is  
checked. Select OK.  
66  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Windows Printing  
5. For:  
Windows 2003 - select Settings > Printers.  
Windows Vista - select Add a Local Printer.  
Windows 7 - select Start > Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers.  
6. Select Add a Printer in the far left column.  
For Windows 7 select Add a network, wireless, or Bluetooth printer.  
7. The Add Printer Wizard window will appear. Select the Next button.  
8. Select The Printer that I want isn’t listed.  
9. Select a shared printer by name.  
10. Type HTTP:// followed by the printer's fully qualified Domain name or IP Address in the URL field.  
The Printer Name can be either the Host Name or the SMB Host Name as shown on the machine  
Configuration Report, depending on the name resolution used by your network (WINS or DNS).  
11. Select the Next button.  
12. Select the Have Disk button and browse to the location of the printer driver and select the OK  
button.  
13. Select the Printer Model and select the OK button.  
14. Select Yes if you want to make this the default printer.  
15. Select Next.  
16. Select Finish.  
Raw TCP/IP Printing (Port 9100)  
Raw TCP/IP is a printing protocol that is similar to LPR printing. Also known as a direct TCP/IP  
connection or sockets interface, it sends information directly to the machine and does not require a  
Line Printer Daemon (LPD). The advantages are that connections stay open for multiple print files and  
spooling is not needed, therefore, printing is faster and more reliable than LPD printing. Raw TCP/IP  
printing is contained in Windows and other third-party applications and operating systems.  
Note Raw TCP/IP Printing is enabled by default for port 9100.  
Information Checklist  
See Configure Static IPv4 Addressing at the Machine.  
How to Configure Port 9100  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Select Properties.  
3. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
4. In the Network Settings link, select Raw TCP/IP, LPR, IPP in the directory tree.  
5. In the Raw TCP/IP Printing area:  
a. Select Enable.  
b. For Port Number, enter the required port number (1 - 65535).  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Windows Printing  
6. Select Apply to save the changes or Undo to return the settings to their previous values.  
Note The settings are not applied until you restart the machine.  
Install Printer Driver  
Refer to Printer Drivers.  
Configure the Windows Printer Driver  
Manual Print Driver Configuration  
To configure the printer driver without using Bi-directional communication:  
Follow the steps below:  
1. Select the Windows Start menu.  
2. Depending on your operating system, navigate to the Printers or Devices and Printers setting.  
3. Select the printer icon and then select Printing preferences.  
4. Select each tab and change any default printer settings as required.  
5. Select Apply.  
6. Select OK.  
Bi-Directional Support  
Follow the steps below that are specific to your operating system:  
1. Select the Windows Start menu.  
2. Depending on your operating system, navigate to the Printers or Devices and Printers setting.  
3. Select the printer icon and then select Printer properties.  
4. Select the Ports tab.  
5. Check the Enable bidirectional support check box.  
Bi-directional communication automatically updates the printer driver with the printer's installed  
options. The driver’s Printing Preferences will report information about the printer's operational  
status, active jobs, completed jobs and paper status.  
6. Select OK.  
68  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
AirPrint  
AirPrint  
AirPrint is a software feature that allows for driverless printing from Apple iOS-based mobile devices  
and Macintosh OS-based devices. AirPrint-enabled printers let you print directly from a Macintosh or  
from an iPhone, iPad, or iPod touch.  
Notes:  
Not all applications support AirPrint.  
Wireless devices must join the same wireless network as the printer.  
For AirPrint to function, both IPP and Bonjour (mDNS) protocols must be enabled.  
The device that submits the AirPrint job must be on the same subnet as the printer. To allow  
devices to print from different subnets, configure your network to pass multicast DNS traffic  
across subnets.  
AirPrint-enabled printers work with iPad (all models), iPhone (3GS or later), and iPod touch  
(3rd generation or later), running the latest version of iOS.  
The Macintosh OS device must be Macintosh OS 10.7 or later.  
1. Open a Web browser, type the IP address of the printer, then press Enter or Return.  
2. Select Login and enter the ID (admin) and Password (1111).  
3. Select Properties > Network Settings > AirPrint.  
4. To enable AirPrint, select Enable.  
Note: AirPrint is enabled by default when IPP and Bonjour (mDNS) are both enabled. Enable these  
settings by selecting Properties > Network Settings > Raw TCP/IP, LPR, IPP and Properties >  
Network Settings > mDNS.  
5. To change the printer name, in the Friendly Name field, enter a new name.  
6. To enter a location for the printer, in the Location field, enter the location of the printer  
7. To enter a physical location for the printer, in the Geographical Location field, enter the  
geographic Latitude and Longitude coordinates in decimal form. For example, use coordinates  
like +170.1234567 and +70.1234567 for a location.  
8. Select Apply.  
9. For the new settings to take effect, restart your printer.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Google Cloud Print  
Google Cloud Print  
Google Cloud Print is a service that allows you to print to a printer using your smart phone, tablet, or  
any other web-connected devices. Just register your Google account with the printer, and you are ready  
to use the Google Cloud Print service. You can print your document or e-mail with Chrome OS, Chrome  
browser, or a Gmail™/ Google Docs™ application on your mobile device, so you don’t need to install the  
printer driver on the mobile device. Refer to the Google web site  
http://www.google.com/cloudprint/learn/ or http://support.google.com/cloudprint) for more  
information about Google Cloud Print.  
Notes:  
Make sure the printer is turned on and connected to a wired or wireless network that has  
access to the Internet.  
Depending on your security configuration, your firewall might not support Google Cloud Print.  
Set up a Google e-mail account.  
Configure the printer to use IPv4.  
Configure Proxy Server settings as needed.  
1. Open a Web browser, type the IP address of the printer, then press Enter or Return.  
2. Select Login and enter the ID (admin) and Password (1111).  
3. Select Properties > Network Settings > Google Cloud Print.  
4. To change the printer name, enter a new name in the Printer Name field.  
5. If you need to enable a proxy server, select Proxy Setting and enter your proxy information.  
6. Select Test Connection to ensure your connection with the printer is successful.  
7. Select Register to register the device to Google Cloud Print.  
Note: If the Claim Url link does not display when you select Register, refresh the CentreWare  
Internet Services page and select Register.  
8. Select the Claim Url that displays. This takes you to the Google Cloud Print web site to finish the  
registration.  
9. Select Finish printer registration.  
10. Now your printer is registered with Google Cloud Print. Select Manage your printer. Google Cloud  
Print - ready devices display in the list.  
70  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scan to PC Setup  
Scan to PC Setup  
This section explains how to configure the Scan to Network and Scan to Local PC features.  
Overview  
The Scan to Network PC feature allows you to scan from your machine to a computer over the network.  
The Scan to Local PC feature allows you to scan from your machine to a computer connected with a  
USB cable.  
Information Checklist  
Ensure the Xerox Easy Printer Manager application is installed.  
Note The Xerox Easy Printer Manager program can only be used in the Windows system.  
Through the Xerox Easy Printer Manager, you can change scan settings and add or delete the folders  
where scanned documents are saved in your computer.  
Note To use the Scan to Local PC feature it is important to select the Recommended installation  
option when you install the Xerox Easy Printer Manager program.  
Scan to Network PC  
1. Open the Xerox Easy Printer Manager application. Select Start, Programs or All Programs, Xerox  
Printers, Xerox Easy Printer Manager and select Easy Printer Manager.  
2. Select the Switch to Advanced Mode button at the top of the window.  
3. Select your machine in the Printer List and add it, if required.  
4. Select the Scan to PC Settings button. The Scan to PC Settings screen appears.  
5. Select Enable Scan from Device Panel.  
6. Select your required settings for Scan Settings:  
Output Color  
Resolution  
Original Size  
7. Select your required settings for File Settings:  
Save To  
File Format  
OCR Language  
Delete Original Image after OCR  
8. Select the required option in the Actions after Saving area:  
Notify me when complete  
Open with Default Application  
E-mail  
None  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Scan to PC Setup  
9. Select Save.  
Scan to Local PC  
This is a basic scanning method for USB-connected machines.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer with a USB cable, and powered on.  
2. Install the Xerox Easy Printer Manager application.  
Note To use the Scan to Local PC feature it is important to select the Recommended installation  
when you install the Xerox Easy Printer Manager program.  
3. Open the Xerox Easy Printer Manager application. Select Start > Programs or All Programs >  
Xerox Printers > Xerox Easy Printer Manager and select Easy Printer Manager.  
4. Select the Switch to Advanced Mode button at the top of the window.  
5. Select your machine in the Printer List if required.  
6. Select the Scan to PC Settings button. The Scan to PC Settings screen appears.  
7. Select Enable Scan from Device Panel.  
8. Select your required settings for Scan Settings:  
Output Color  
Resolution  
Original Size  
9. Select your required settings for File Settings:  
Save To  
File Format  
OCR Language  
Delete Original Image after OCR  
10. Select the required option in the Actions after Saving area:  
Notify me when complete  
Open with Default Application  
E-mail  
None  
11. Select Save.  
72  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fax Setup  
Fax Setup  
This section explains how to set up the Fax feature of the machine.  
Overview  
The Fax feature enables users to send hard copy documents to another fax machine (or multiple fax  
machines) via a dedicated phone line connection.  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
Ensure that the machine is fully functioning in its existing configuration.  
Ensure that the machine has access to a telephone connection.  
Obtain the telephone number that you will configure as the machine's fax number.  
Connect your telephone cable(s) to the fax port(s) on the machine.  
Enable Fax from the Machine  
1. Press the Machine Status button.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select Fax Setup; press OK.  
3. If prompted, enter the Administrator Password (1111).  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Enable/Disable.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select Enable.  
6. Press OK.  
Test the Fax  
1. At the machine, press the Fax button on the control panel.  
2. Enter the number of a nearby fax machine using the alphanumerical keypad.  
3. Place your documents in the document handler and press the Start button.  
4. Verify that your documents are received at the other fax machine.  
Fax Defaults Using CentreWare Internet Services  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Machine Settings link, select the Fax link.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Fax Setup  
6. Select the General link.  
7. In the Machine ID & Fax Number area:  
a. Enter an ID in the Machine ID field.  
b. Enter the fax number in the Fax Number field.  
8. In the Change Default area:  
a. From the Resolution drop-down menu select one of the available options:  
b. From the Lighten/Darken drop-down menu select one of the available options  
c. Select the required option for Original Size.  
9. In the Sending area:  
a. From the Redial Term drop-down menu select the minutes for the term of each redial.  
b. From the Redial Times drop-down menu select the amount of times you want the machine  
to re-dial.  
c. If your telephone system requires you to enter a prefix in front of fax numbers, select Enable  
and enter prefix dial details in the Prefix Dial field.  
d. Select the ECM Mode check box to enable Error Correction Mode.  
e. From the Fax Confirmation drop-down menu select one of the send report options.  
Off  
On - prints a report when a fax has been sent.  
On-Error - prints a report when an error occurs.  
10. In the Receiving area:  
a. From the Receive Mode drop-down menu select the required option for the line:  
Tel - receives a fax by picking up the handset.  
Fax - answers an incoming fax call and immediately goes into the fax reception mode.  
Ans/Fax - select when an answering machine is attached to the machine.  
b. From the Ring to Answer drop-down menu select the number of times the machine should  
ring before answering.  
c. Select the Stamp Receive Name check box to enable the machine to print a page number  
and the date and time of receipt on the bottom of each page of a received fax.  
d. Select the Receive Start Code check box to initiate fax reception from an extension phone  
plugged into the socket on the back of the machine. Select the required start code from the  
menu (the default is 9).  
e. From the Secure Receive drop-down menu, select one of the following options to allow the  
machine to hold received faxes in the job queue as Secure Receive fax jobs. The held faxes will  
remain in the queue and will only be released from the queue when the user enters the  
release password.  
Off  
On - this option requires you to enter a Secure Receive passcode and select Apply.  
Print fax in secure receive mode - this option is only available when On is selected from  
the Secure Receive menu. Select the Print button and enter the Secure Receive passcode.  
Select Apply.  
f. Select the Auto Reduction check box to automatically reduce large documents received to fit  
on the fax paper size of your machine.  
74  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax Setup  
g. In the Discard Size field, enter details of the fax size that can be discarded.  
Note Discard Size is not available with Auto Reduction.  
h. From the 2-Sided drop-down menu select one of the following options for printing on both  
sides of the page:  
Off  
Long Edge - prints on both sides along the long edges of the page.  
Short Edge - prints on both sides along the short edges of the page  
11. Select Apply to save the changes.  
12. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Adjusting Fax Document Settings at the Machine  
Before starting a fax, change the settings for the fax options according to your original document to  
get the best quality. See the Fax chapter of the User Guide for detailed steps on faxing.  
Fax Address Book  
So set up an address book for fax, refer to the Address Book chapter of this User Guide.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
E-mail Setup  
E-mail Setup  
This section explains how to set up the E-mail feature of the machine.  
Overview  
The E-mail feature enables a user to scan paper documents into an electronic format and send those  
documents to one or more e-mail recipients.  
Authentication (Service Access Control) can be enabled on the machine to prevent unauthorized  
access to the network options. If Authentication is enabled a user will be prompted to enter user  
account details, before they can access the E-mail feature. Authentication prevents a user from sending  
an anonymous e-mail from the machine.  
E-mail Addressing  
Recipient addresses can be added using any one of the three methods listed below:  
Enter a recipient address manually at the e-mail keyboard screen. e.g. [email protected].  
Look up a recipient address using LDAP (Lightweight Directory Access Protocol), and/or perform a  
look up using the Local Address book. LDAP provides access to the global, or corporate address  
book. Refer to LDAP Configuration and Address Books.  
Enter a recipient using the .com key (Smart Key). The Smart Key can be programmed to enter full  
e-mail address e.g. [email protected], or the Smart Key can be programmed to append a  
domain address, e.g. @company.com. The end user can then enter part of an e-mail address and  
press the .com key to append the domain address to his entry.  
Information Checklist  
Before starting, ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
Ensure that the machine is fully functioning on the network.  
TCP/IP and HTTP protocols must be enabled on the machine so that the machine web browser  
can be accessed. Ensure that the DNS settings are configured correctly.  
Obtain the address of a functional SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol) mail server that accepts  
inbound mail traffic.  
Create an e-mail account which the machine will use as the default From address.  
Test the e-mail account by sending an e-mail to the machine’s account. This task should be  
completed at a mail client on your network that supports SMTP and POP3 (Post Office Protocol 3).  
Configure SMTP  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
76  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
E-mail Setup  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Network Settings link select the Outgoing Mail Server (SMTP) link.  
6. In the Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) area:  
a. Enter the IP or host name of the SMTP Server.  
b. Enter the Port Number. The Port field can have a value from 1 to 65535. The default Port  
Number is 25.  
c. Select the SMTP Requires Authentication check box if your mail server requires the machine  
to log in.  
d. Enter details in the Login ID and Password fields required for the machine to authenticate at  
the mail server.  
e. Enter a password in the Confirm Password field.  
f. Select POP3 Authentication to enable this option and enter the required settings.  
g. In the Advanced area, select Secure E-mail Connection with SSL/TLS if this option is  
required.  
h. Enter a value for server connection timeout in the SMTP Server Connection Timeout field.  
The range is 30 - 120 seconds, and the default is 30 seconds.  
i.  
j.  
Enter the required details for the Default From Address.  
From the Maximum Message Size drop-down menu, select a value between 1MB - 10MB.  
Larger scans will be sent as multiple e-mail messages, divided at page breaks.  
k. Select the SMTP Configuration Test button to test your settings.  
7. Select Apply to save the changes.  
8. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Configure the Feature  
This feature allows you to configure the default settings for e-mail jobs.  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Machine Settings link select the Scan link.  
6. Select Change Default.  
7. In the Scan to E-mail area:  
a. Select one of the following e-mail types from the Original Type drop-down menu:  
Text  
Text / Photo  
Photo  
b. Select one of the following e-mail types from the Original Size drop-down menu:  
Letter  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
E-mail Setup  
Legal  
A4  
Folio  
A5  
B5(JIS)  
Executive  
c. Select one of the following scanning resolutions from the Resolution drop-down menu:  
100 dpi  
200 dpi  
300 dpi  
d. Select one of the following scan color types from the Output Color drop-down menu:  
Black and White  
Grayscale  
Color  
e. Select one of the following e-mail attachment format types from the File Format drop-down  
menu:  
Multi-PDF  
Multi-TIFF  
Single TIFF  
JPEG  
Single-PDF  
f. Select the required option for Lighten/Darken.  
8. Select Apply to save the changes.  
9. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
10. Select Scan to E-mail in the left hand menu.  
a. Enter a valid e-mail address in the Default From: Address field.  
b. Enter required information in the Default Subject field.  
c. Deselect the Use default message on Scan To E-mail check box to change default mail text.  
d. For the Smart Key Address #1 - Smart Key Address #6 fields enter details of default fixed  
details for each numerical key. The default settings for commonly used addresses are already  
configured for .com, .org, .net, .gov and .tv.  
e. Select the check boxes to enable Edit From Address and Replace From Address if required.  
f. Check the Auto Send To Self check box to automatically add the sender’s From: address to  
the recipient list.  
g. Select an option from the Print Confirmation Sheet drop-down menu:  
On Errors Only - This setting will produce a Confirmation Sheet only when error  
information is indicated.  
Always - This setting will produce a Confirmation Sheet that will provide error  
information and indication that the job has reached the recipient(s).  
Never - This setting will not produce a Confirmation Sheet.  
11. Select Apply to save the changes.  
78  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-mail Setup  
12. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
LDAP Configuration and Address Books  
This section explains how to install and set up Address Books.  
Overview  
The machine supports two types of address book:  
Global  
A global address book provided by Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) services stored on  
a remote server.  
Local  
An address book created from a list of addresses saved in a .csv file (Comma Separated by Values)  
format stored locally on the machine.  
Both address book types can be configured for use on the machine at the same time.  
LDAP is used to access the Corporate Address Book to locate e-mail addresses and other information  
for use with many of the services.  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
Ensure your network supports LDAP services.  
Obtain the IP Address or Host Name of your LDAP Server. The machine may also need a login  
name and password if the LDAP server is not configured to allow Anonymous connection.  
Use an LDAP client to validate your settings before inputting them into the CentreWare Internet  
Services menus. LDAP clients include Microsoft Outlook Express, Microsoft Outlook and Lotus  
Notes and other e-mail clients.  
To use host names, DNS must be configured on the machine.  
LDAP Configuration  
General Settings  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side select the Network Security link.  
6. Select External Authentication.  
7. Select LDAP Server.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
E-mail Setup  
8. In the LDAP Server area enter the IP address or host name and Port Number of the LDAP server.  
9. Select the required option for Match User’s Login ID to the following LDAP attribute.  
10. In the Secure LDAP Connection area, select the Enable check box to enable Secure LDAP via  
SSL.  
11. Enter the required information in the LDAP User Search field:  
Search Root Directory - allows you to limit the LDAP search by entering the location on  
the server where the user information is stored.  
Authentication Methods - select either Anonymous or Simple to access the LDAP  
server.  
If you selected Simple for Authentication Methods, enter the required Login ID and Password.  
You can check the Enable check box for Append Root to Base DN.  
When enabled the bind will append the Root to Append string to the authenticate user login IDs.  
This should be enabled whenever the Windows Login attribute is UserPrincipalName. A typical  
Root to Append may look like “@yourcompany.com.”  
Note Many Unix/Linux LDAP servers require this attribute to be set and it is used frequently when  
Authentication Methods is set to Simple.  
12. Enter the required option for Maximum Number of Search Results. For Maximum Number of  
Search Results, enter amount between 0, 5-300. This is the maximum number of addresses that  
will appear which match the search criteria selected by the user. Set the search results to one less  
than the server will allow. For example, if the LDAP server limit is 75, set the search results to 74 or  
less. A zero value will attempt to return all searches.  
13. For Search Timeout, enter the required setting for the search timeout (0, 5-100 seconds).  
14. Select LDAP Referral if this option is required.  
15. The Search By option offers 4 ways to search the address list depending on the name syntax used  
in your environment. Select one of the following search types:  
Common Name - names are listed by the Common Name LDAP attribute. Common  
Name is the default option.  
E-mail Address - names are listed by e-mail address.  
Surname/Given name - names are listed by Surname (Last Name) then Given Name  
(First Name).  
Custom - Select Custom to enter the required search information in the Custom Search  
box.  
The Search Name Order option will help control the returns by allowing the LDAP query to be on  
Common Name or Surname.  
16. Select the LDAP Configuration Test button to test your LDAP settings.  
17. Select Apply to save the changes.  
18. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Verify the LDAP Settings  
1. At the machine, press the E-mail button on the control panel.  
2. If Authentication is enabled, enter your Login ID and Password (if required).  
3. The Enter From Address screen displays.  
80  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-mail Setup  
4. Enter a few letters of a name in the LDAP Address Book. The machine will return matching names.  
5. Press the up/down arrows until the name you want displays and press OK.  
6. The Enter Destination Addresses screen displays.  
7. Enter a destination e-mail address.  
8. When Another Address? displays, press the up/down arrows to select Yes or No and press OK.  
9. Highlight the required File Format and press OK.  
10. Enter an e-mail subject and press OK.  
11. Place a document in the document handler and press the Start button.  
12. Verify that the recipient receives the scanned document in their e-mail inbox.  
Address Book  
To set up an address book for e-mail, refer to the Address Book chapter of this User Guide.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
E-mail Setup  
82  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper and Media  
3
This chapter contains information about the different types of stock and stock sizes that can be used  
on your machine, available paper trays, and the types of stock and sizes supported by each tray.  
This chapter includes:  
Loading Paper  
Setting Paper Size and Type  
Media Specifications  
Loading Documents  
Media Output Locations  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading Paper  
Loading Paper  
One paper tray and a manual feed slot are standard on your machine.  
Various media sizes and types can be used in the trays. For more media specifications, refer to Media  
Specifications.  
Preparing Paper for Loading  
Before loading paper into the paper trays, flex or fan the  
edges of the paper stack. This procedure separates any sheets  
of paper that are stuck together and reduces the possibility of  
paper jams.  
Note: To avoid unnecessary paper jams and misfeeds do  
not remove paper from its packaging until required.  
Loading Tray 1  
The paper level indicator on the front of tray 1 shows the  
amount of paper currently left in the tray. When the tray is  
empty, the indicator is completely lowered as shown in the  
illustration: 1 shows full, 2 shows empty.  
Using the instructions provided below, load paper into the  
machine. Tray 1 holds up to 250 sheets of 20 lb (80 g/m²)  
paper, A4 and letter only. It holds fewer sheets of other media  
sizes. For more media specifications, refer to Media  
Specifications.  
1. Pull out tray 1 and load paper into the tray, print side  
down. Do not fill above the Maximum Fill line indicated  
by the symbol  
.
84  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Loading Paper  
2. To accommodate longer paper, press the paper tray  
extender lever (1) and slide the lever to the desired  
position. Press and slide the paper length guide (2) until  
it lightly touches the end of the paper stack.  
3. Position the width guide by pressing the lever and sliding  
it towards the stack of paper, until it gently touches the  
side of the stack.  
4. Insert the paper tray into the machine.  
5. After loading paper in the paper tray, set the paper size  
and type using the control panel. Press OK to confirm the  
settings or Back to change the settings.  
6. When printing from your computer, ensure you select the  
Paper tab in the print driver to specify the correct paper  
size and type. Not confirming the paper details may  
result in printing delays. For information about setting  
the paper type and size on the control panel, refer to Setting Paper Size and Type.  
Note: The settings made from the printer driver on your computer override the settings on the  
control panel.  
Using the Manual Feed Slot  
The manual feed slot is located on the front of your machine. It can be closed when not in use, making  
the product more compact. Use the manual feed slot to print transparencies, labels, envelopes, or  
postcards in addition to making quick runs of paper types or sizes that are not currently loaded in the  
paper tray.  
When using the manual feed slot for special media it may be necessary to use the rear cover for the  
output. For further information, refer to Media Output Locations.  
Acceptable print media is plain paper from 3.0 x 5.0 inches to 8.5 x 14 inches Legal (76 mm x 127 mm  
to 216 mm x 356 mm) and weighing between 16 lb and 58 lb (60 g/m²and 220 g/m²). For more media  
specifications, refer to Media Specifications.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading Paper  
Loading the Manual Feed Slot  
1. Press to open the manual feed slot, located on the front  
of the machine.  
Note: The manual feed slot holds 1 sheet of the following  
media: 20 lb (80 g/m²) plain paper, transparency, label,  
envelope, or cardstock.  
2. Load the print material between the width guides with  
the print side facing up.  
Note: Hold a transparency by the edge and avoid  
touching the print side.  
3. Adjust the paper guide to the width of the print material.  
Note: If the media prints with curl, wrinkles, a crease, or  
black bold lines, open the rear cover and print again.  
4. When printing from your computer, ensure you select the  
Paper tab button to specify the correct paper size and type. For the source, you must select  
Manual Feeder. Not confirming the paper details may result in printing delays. For information  
about setting the paper type and size on the control panel, refer to Setting Paper Size and Type.  
Note: The settings made from the printer driver on your computer override the settings on the  
control panel.  
86  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading Paper  
Envelope Mode  
1. Press to open the manual feed slot, located on the front  
of the machine.  
2. Remove any curl on the envelope before loading it into  
the manual feed slot.  
Note: For more information on media specifications,  
refer to Media Specifications.  
3. Load the envelope short edge feed and with the flap  
facing down as shown in the illustration.  
4. Adjust the paper guide to the width of the print material.  
Note: If the media prints with curl, wrinkles, a crease, or  
black bold lines, open the rear cover and print again.  
5. When printing from your computer, ensure you press the  
Paper tab to specify the correct paper size and type. For  
the source, you must select Manual Feed Slot. Not  
confirming the paper details may result in printing  
delays.  
Note: For information about setting the paper type and size on the control panel, refer to Setting  
Paper Size and Type.  
Note: The settings made from the printer driver on your computer override the settings on the  
control panel.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Paper Size and Type  
Setting Paper Size and Type  
After loading paper in the paper tray, set the paper size and type using the control panel. These  
settings will apply to Copy and Fax modes. For computer printing, select the paper size and type in the  
application program you use on your computer.  
Note: The settings made from the printer driver on your computer override the settings on the  
control panel.  
Alternatively, to change the paper size and type on your computer, select Xerox Easy Printer Manager  
>
(Switch to advanced mode) > Device Settings.  
Setting the Paper Size  
1. Press Machine Status on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Paper Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Paper Size and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select the paper tray you want and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrows to select the paper size you want.  
7. Press OK to save the selection.  
8. Press Back until you return to Ready mode.  
If you want to use special sized paper, select a custom paper size in the printer driver.  
Setting the Paper Type  
1. Press Machine Status on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Paper Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Paper Type and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select the paper tray you want and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrows to select the paper type you want.  
7. Press OK to save the selection.  
8. Press Back until you return to Ready mode.  
Setting the Paper Source  
1. Press Machine Status on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select System Setup and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Paper Setup and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Paper Source and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select Copy Tray or Print Tray and press OK.  
6. Press the up/down arrows to select the paper tray you want.  
88  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setting Paper Size and Type  
7. Press OK to save the selection.  
8. Press Back until you return to Ready mode.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Media Specifications  
Media Specifications  
Media Guidelines  
When selecting or loading paper, envelopes, or other special media please adhere to these guidelines:  
Attempting to print on damp, curled, wrinkled, or torn paper can cause paper jams and poor print  
quality.  
Use only high quality copier grade paper. Avoid paper with embossed lettering, perforations, or  
texture that is too smooth or too rough.  
Store paper in its ream wrapper until ready to use. Place cartons on pallets or shelves, not on the  
floor. Do not place heavy objects on top of the paper, whether it is packaged or unpackaged. Keep  
it away from moisture or other conditions that can cause it to wrinkle or curl.  
During storage, moisture-proof wrap (any plastic container or bag) should be used to prevent dust  
and moisture from contaminating your paper.  
Always use paper and other media that conforms to the specifications.  
Use only well-constructed envelopes with sharp, well creased folds:  
DO NOT use envelopes with clasps and snaps.  
DO NOT use envelopes with windows, coated lining, self-adhesive seals, or other synthetic  
materials.  
DO NOT use damaged or poorly made envelopes.  
Only use the special media recommended for use in laser printers.  
To prevent special media such as transparencies and label sheets from sticking together, remove  
them from the rear cover as they are printed.  
Place transparencies on a flat surface after removing them from the machine.  
Do not leave the special media in the manual feed slot for long periods of time. Dust and dirt may  
accumulate on them resulting in spotty printing.  
To avoid smudging caused by fingerprints, handle transparencies and coated paper carefully.  
To avoid fading, do not expose the printed transparencies to prolonged sunlight.  
Store unused media at temperatures between 59°F and 86°F (15°C to 30°C). The relative humidity  
should be between 10% and 70%.  
When loading paper, do not fill above the Maximum Fill line indicated by the symbol  
Verify that your labels’ adhesive material can tolerate fusing temperature of 200 C (392 F) for 0.1  
second.  
.
o
o
Ensure that there is no exposed adhesive material between labels.  
CAUTION: Exposed areas can cause labels to peel off during printing, which can cause paper  
jams. Exposed adhesive can also cause damage to machine components.  
Do not feed a sheet of labels through the machine more than once. The adhesive backing is  
designed for one pass only through the machine.  
Do not use labels that are separating from the backing sheet or are wrinkled, bubbled, or  
otherwise damaged.  
90  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Media Specifications  
Media Types  
Note: Some features may not be available on your model. Check your machine type in Getting  
Started.  
The table below shows the media types supported for Copy, Print, or Fax for each tray for the following  
paper sizes:  
A4  
8.27 x 11.69 inches (210 x 297 mm)  
8.5 x 11.0 inches (216 x 279 mm)  
8.5 x 14.0 inches (216 x 355 mm)  
8.5 x 13.5 inches (216 x 343 mm)  
8.5 x 13.0 inches (216 x 330 mm)  
Letter  
Legal  
Oficio  
Folio  
Key:  
O
Supported  
X
Not Supported  
Bypass  
Tray  
Duplex  
Unit  
Types  
Supported Weights  
Tray 1  
Plain  
Thick  
O
O
X
O
X
X
X
O
X
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
X
O
X
X
X
O
X
19 to 24 lb (70 to 90 g/m²)  
24 to 28 lb (91 to 105 g/m²)  
43 to 58 lb (164 to 220 g/m²)  
16 to 18 lb (60 to 70 g/m²)  
20 to 24 lb (75 to 90 g/m²)  
20 to 24 lb (75 to 90 g/m²)  
20 to 24 lb (75 to 90 g/m²)  
19 to 24 lb (70 to 90 g/m²)  
37 to 39 lb (138 to 146 g/m²)  
Thicker  
Thin  
Cotton  
Colored  
Preprinted  
Recycled  
Transparency  
(A4 / Letter only)  
Labels  
X
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
X
X
O
X
32 to 40 lb (120 to 150 g/m²)  
32 to 43 lb (121 to 163 g/m²)  
28 to 32 lb (105 to 120 g/m²)  
Card Stock  
Bond  
Archival  
28 to 32 lb (105 to 120 g/m²) if you  
need to keep the print-out for a long  
period time, such as archives, select  
this option  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Media Specifications  
The table below shows the media types supported for Print for each tray for the following paper sizes:  
JIS B5  
ISO B5  
Executive  
A5  
7.17 x 10.12 inches (182 x 257 mm)  
6.93 x 9.84 inches (176 x 250 mm)  
7.25 x 10.50 inches (184.2 x 266.7 mm)  
5.85 x 8.27 inches (148.5 x 210 mm)  
4.13 x 5.85 inches (105 x 148.5 mm)  
4 x 6 inches (101.6 x 152.4 mm)  
A6  
Postcard  
Monarch  
Envelopes  
3.88 x 7.5 inches (98.4 x 190.5 mm)  
DL Envelopes  
C5 Envelopes  
C6 Envelopes  
No.10 Envelopes  
4.33 x 8.66 inches (110 x 220 mm)  
6.38 x 9.02 inches (162.0 x 229 mm)  
4.49 x 6.38 inches (114 x 162 mm)  
4.12 x 9.5 inches (105 x 241 mm)  
Key:  
O
Supported  
X
Not Supported  
Bypass  
Tray  
Duplex  
Unit  
Types  
Supported Weights  
Tray 1  
Plain  
O
O
X
O
X
X
X
O
X
X
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
19 to 24 lb (70 to 90 g/m²)  
24 to 28 lb (91 to 105 g/m²)  
43 to 58 lb (164 to 220 g/m²)  
16 to 18 lb (60 to 70 g/m²)  
20 to 24 lb (75 to 90 g/m²)  
20 to 24 lb (75 to 90 g/m²)  
20 to 24 lb (75 to 90 g/m²)  
19 to 24 lb (70 to 90 g/m²)  
32 to 43 lb (121 to 163 g/m²) card stock  
20 to 24 lb (75 to 90 g/m²)  
Thick  
Thicker  
Thin  
Cotton  
Colored  
Preprinted  
Recycled  
Postcard  
Envelopes  
92  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading Documents  
Loading Documents  
Documents can be loaded either into the automatic document feeder or onto the platen glass.  
Note: Some features may not be available on your model. Check your machine type in Getting  
Started.  
Automatic Document Feeder  
The automatic document feeder can hold a maximum of 40  
originals of 20 lb (80 g/m²) thickness.  
1. Load documents to be scanned face up in the input tray  
of the automatic document feeder with the top of the  
document to the left of the tray.  
2. Move the document guide to just touch both sides of the  
document.  
Platen Glass  
The platen glass can be used for oversized, torn, or damaged  
originals, and for books and magazines.  
1. Open the automatic document feeder and place single  
documents face down on the platen glass aligned with  
the rear left corner.  
2. The default document size is 8.5 x 11” or A4. For other  
sized documents, change the Original Size option. Refer  
to Copy Options.  
Note: Documents are only scanned once even when  
several copies are selected.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Media Output Locations  
Media Output Locations  
Note: Some features may not be available on your model. Check your machine type in Getting  
Started.  
The machine has two output locations:  
Output tray, face down, up to a maximum of 120 sheets  
of 20 lb (80 g/m²) paper, 10 transparencies and 10  
sheets of labels.  
Rear cover, face up, one sheet at a time.  
The machine sends output to the output tray by default. If  
special media, such as envelopes, print out with wrinkles, curl,  
creases, or black bold lines, the rear cover should be used for  
the output. Open the rear cover and keep it open while  
printing one sheet at a time.  
Note: The rear cover output can only be used for simplex  
jobs. Duplex printing with the rear door open will cause  
paper jams.  
Using the Output Tray  
The output tray collects printed paper face down, in the order in which the sheets were printed. The  
output tray should be used for most jobs.  
To use the output tray, make sure that the rear cover is closed.  
Notes:  
If paper coming out of the output tray has problems, such as excessive curl, try printing  
to the rear cover.  
To reduce paper jams, do not open or close the rear cover while the printer is printing.  
94  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Media Output Locations  
Using the Rear Cover  
When using the rear cover, paper comes out of the machine  
face up. Printing from the manual feed slot to the rear cover  
provides a straight paper path and might improve the output  
quality when printing on special media. Whenever the rear  
cover is open, the output is delivered there.  
Note: The rear cover output can only be used for simplex  
jobs. Duplex printing with the rear cover open causes  
paper jams.  
CAUTION: The fuser area inside the rear cover of your machine becomes very hot when in use.  
Take care when you access this area.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Media Output Locations  
96  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Print  
4
This product produces high quality prints from electronic documents. You can access the printer from  
your computer by installing the appropriate printer driver. To access the many printer drivers which can  
site at www.xerox.com.  
This chapter includes:  
Printing using Windows  
Xerox Easy Printer Manager (EPM)  
Printing using Macintosh  
Printing using Linux  
Printing using Unix  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing using Windows  
Printing using Windows  
The following provides an overview of the print procedure and features available when printing using  
Windows.  
Notes:  
Some options may be unavailable depending on your printer model and configuration.  
Images are representative only.  
Print Procedure  
Documents can be printed from your computer using the printer drivers supplied. The printer driver  
must be loaded on each PC which uses the machine for printing.  
Note: When you select an option in Printing Properties or Preferences, you may see a warning  
mark  
or  
. A  
mark means you can select that certain option but it is not recommended,  
and a  
mark means you cannot select that option due to the machine setting or environment.  
1. Select Print in your application.  
2. From the Printer: Name drop- down menu, select your machine.  
3. Select Properties or Preferences to make your print selections on the individual tabs. For more  
information refer to the following:  
Favorites Tab  
Basic Tab  
Paper Tab  
Graphics Tab  
Advanced Tab  
Earth Smart Tab  
Xerox Tab  
4. Select OK to confirm your selections.  
5. Select OK to print your document.  
Favorites Tab  
The Favorites tab lists lists default favorites and user-generated favorites.  
The Favorites option, which is visible on each tab except for the Xerox tab, allows you to save the  
current preferences for future use.  
To save a Favorites item, follow these steps:  
1. Change the settings as needed on each tab.  
2. Click Save.  
3. Enter a name and a description, and then select the desired icon.  
98  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Printing using Windows  
4. Click OK. When you save Favorites, all current driver settings are saved.  
To use a saved setting, select it in the Favorites tab. The machine is now set to print according to the  
settings you have selected.  
To delete a saved setting, select it in the Favorites tab and click Delete.  
Note: Only user-generated favorites can be deleted.  
Preview Tab  
The Preview tab, in the right panel, is visible only on the Favorites tab. It displays a graphical summary  
of your selections.  
Details Tab  
The Details tab, in the right panel, is visible only on the Favorites tab. It displays a summary of the  
selected Favorite and notes incompatioable options.  
Paper Tab  
The Paper tab, in the right panel, is visible on each main tab except for the Favorites and Xerox tabs. It  
displays a graphical summary of your selections.  
Device Tab  
The Device tab, in the right panel, is visible on each main tab except for the Favorites and Xerox tabs. It  
displays a summary of the device settings.  
Printer Status  
Note: The Printer Status window and its contents shown in this user guide may differ depending  
on the machine or operating system in use.  
The Printer Status option, which is visible on each tab, monitors and informs you of the machine  
status. The Xerox Printer Status dialog includes the following options:  
Toner Level  
You can view the level of toner remaining in each toner cartridge. The machine and the number of  
toner cartridge(s) shown in the window may differ depending on the machine in use. Some machines  
do not have this feature.  
Option  
You can set printing job alert related settings.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing using Windows  
Order Supplies  
You can order replacement toner cartridge(s) from online.  
User’s Guide  
This button opens the user guide when an error occurs. You can then open the troubleshooting section  
in the user guide.  
Basic Tab  
The Basic tab provides selections for the print mode to use and options to adjust how the document  
appears on the printed page. These options include orientation settings, quality settings, layout  
options, and 2-sided printing settings.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your printer model and configuration.  
Orientation  
Orientation allows you to select the direction in which information is printed on a page.  
Portrait: Prints across the width of the page, letter style.  
Landscape: Prints across the length of the page, spreadsheet style.  
Rotate 180 Degrees: Allows you to rotate the page 180degrees.  
Layout Options  
Layout Options allow you to select a different layout for your output. You can select the number of  
pages to print on a single sheet of paper. To print more than one page per sheet, the pages will be  
reduced in size and arranged in the order you specify.  
Single Page Per Side: Use this option if the layout does not require changing.  
Multiple Pages Per Side: Use this option to print multiple pages on each page. You can print up to  
16 pages on one sheet. Select the number of images required on each side, the page order and if  
borders are required.  
Poster Printing: Use this option to divide a single-page document onto 4, 9 or 16 segments. Each  
segment will be printed on a single sheet of paper for the purpose of pasting the sheets together  
to form one poster-size document. Select Poster 2x2 for 4 pages, Poster 3x3 for 9 pages, or Poster  
4x4 for 16 pages. Then choose the overlap amount in mm or inches.  
Booklet Printing: This allows you to print your document on both sides of the paper and arrange  
the pages so that the paper can be folded in half after printing to produce a booklet.  
Page Border: Use this option to select from a variety of borders for your output.  
100  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing using Windows  
2-Sided Printing  
You can print on both sides of a sheet of paper. Before printing, decide how you want your document  
oriented.  
Note: Some features may not be available on your model.  
Printer Default: If you select this option, this feature is determined by the settings made on the  
control panel of the printer.  
None: The document is printed single-sided.  
Long Edge: This is the conventional layout used in book binding.  
Short Edge: This is the type often used with calendars.  
Reverse 2-Sided Printing: The document is printed two-sided and the second side images are  
rotated 180 degrees.  
Paper Tab  
Use the Paper Tab options to set the basic paper handling specifications when you access the printer  
properties.  
Copies  
This allows you to choose the number of copies to be printed. You can select 1 to 999 copies.  
Paper Options  
Original Size: This allows you to set the size of the original you are printing. If the required size is  
not listed in the Size box, select Edit: When the Custom Paper Size Settings window appears, set  
the paper size and select OK. The setting appears in the list so that you can select it.  
Output Size: This allows you to set the size of paper required for printing.  
Percentage: Use this option to change the contents of a page to appear larger or smaller on the  
printed page. Enter the scaling rate in the Percentage input box.  
Source: Use this option to select the paper tray required. Use Manual Feeder when printing on  
special materials like envelopes and transparencies. If the paper source is set to Auto Select, the  
printer automatically selects the paper source based on the requested size.  
Type: Set Type to correspond to the paper loaded in the tray selected. This will provide the best  
quality printout. If printing Envelopes, ensure Envelope is selected.  
Advanced: The advanced paper options allow you to select a different paper source for the first  
page of your document.  
First Page: To have the first page printed on a different paper type from the rest of the  
document select the paper tray containing the paper required.  
Source: Use this option to select the paper tray required. Use Manual Feeder when printing  
on special materials like envelopes and transparencies. If the paper source is set to Auto  
Select: The printer automatically selects the paper source based on the requested size.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing using Windows  
Graphics Tab  
Use the following options to adjust the print quality for your specific printing needs.  
Quality  
This option allows you to select Standard or High Resolution graphics.  
Font/Text  
All Text Black: Select this check box to have all text in your document print in solid black,  
regardless of the color it appears on the screen.  
Advanced: Use this option to set font options. True Type fonts can be downloaded as Outline or  
Bitmap Images or printed as Graphics. Select the Use Printer Fonts option if the fonts do not  
require downloading and the printer fonts should be used.  
Graphic Controller  
Advanced: Use this option to adjust the brightness and contrast levels.  
Toner Saver  
Select On to save toner.  
Advanced Tab  
You can select Advanced output options for your document, such as watermarks or overlay text.  
102  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing using Windows  
Watermark  
This option allows you to print text over an existing document. There are several predefined  
watermarks that come with the printer which can be modified, or you can add new ones to the list.  
Using an Existing Watermark  
Select the required watermark from the Watermark drop-down list. You will see the selected watermark  
in the preview image.  
Creating a Watermark  
1. Select Edit from the Watermark drop-down list. The Edit Watermark window appears.  
2. Enter a text message in the Watermark Message box. You can enter up to 40 characters. The  
message displays in the preview window. When the First Page Only box is checked, the watermark  
prints on the first page only.  
3. Select the watermark options. You can select the font name, style, size, or shade from the Font  
Attributes section and set the angle of the watermark from the Message Angle section.  
4. Select Add to add the new watermark to the list.  
5. When you have finished editing, select OK.  
Editing a Watermark  
1. Select Edit from the Watermark drop-down list. The Edit Watermark window appears.  
2. Select the watermark you want to edit from the Current Watermarks list and change the  
watermark message options.  
3. Select Update to save the changes.  
4. When you have finished editing, select OK.  
Deleting a Watermark  
1. Select Edit from the Watermark drop-down list. The Edit Watermark window appears.  
2. Select the watermark you want to delete from the Current Watermarks list and select Delete.  
3. Select OK.  
Overlay  
An overlay is text and/or images stored on the computer hard disk drive as a special file format that  
can be printed on any document. Overlays are often used to take the place of preprinted forms and  
letterhead paper.  
Note: This option is only available when you use the PCL6 Printer Driver.  
Creating a New Page Overlay  
To use a page overlay, you must first create one containing your logo or another image.  
1. Create or open a document containing text or an image for use in a new page overlay. Position the  
items exactly as you want them to appear when printed as an overlay.  
2. Select Edit from the Overlay drop-down list. The Edit Overlay window appears.  
3. Select Create and type a name in the File name box. Select the destination path, if necessary.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing using Windows  
4. Select Save. The name appears in the Overlay List box.  
5. Select OK.  
Note: The overlay document size must be the same as the documents you print with the overlay.  
Do not create an overlay with a watermark.  
6. Select OK on the Advanced tab page.  
7. Select OK in the main Print window.  
8. An Are you Sure? message displays. Select Yes to confirm.  
Using a Page Overlay  
1. Select the required overlay from the Overlay drop-down list box.  
If the overlay file you want does not appear in the overlay list, select the Edit button and Load  
Overlay, and select the Overlay file.  
If you have stored the overlay file you want to use in an external source, you can also load the file  
when you access the Load Overlay window.  
After you select the file, select Open. The file appears in the Overlay List box and is available for  
printing. Select the overlay from the Overlay List box.  
2. If necessary, select Confirm Page Overlay When Printing. If this box is checked, a message  
window appears each time you submit a document for printing, asking you to confirm your wish to  
print an overlay on your document.  
If this box is not checked and an overlay has been selected, the overlay automatically prints with  
your document.  
3. Select OK.  
Deleting a Page Overlay  
1. Select Edit from the Overlay drop-down list. The Edit Overlay window appears.  
2. Select the Overlay you want to delete from the Overlay List box.  
3. Select Delete Overlay. When a confirming message window appears, select Yes.  
4. Select OK.  
Output Options  
Select the required Print order from the drop-down list box:  
Normal: All pages are printed.  
Reverse All Pages: Your printer prints all pages from the last page to the first page.  
Print Odd Pages: Your printer prints only the odd numbered pages of the document.  
Print Even Pages: Your printer prints only the even numbered pages of the document.  
Select the Skip Blank Pages check box if you do not want blank pages to be printed.  
To add a binding margin, select the Manual Margin check box and select Details to select the margin  
position and width.  
104  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing using Windows  
Earth Smart Tab  
The Earth Smart tab provides options to decrease the amount of energy and paper used in the  
printing process and displays a visual representation of the savings made.  
Note: This Tab option may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
Type  
The Type drop-down list is used to select the main Earth Smart option for the printer.  
None: No energy or paper saving options are automatically selected.  
Earth Smart Printing: When this option is selected, 2 Sided Printing, Layout, Skip Blank Pages,  
and Toner Save can be customized to suit requirements.  
Printer Default:This option automatically selects the printer default settings.  
Result Simulator  
This area of the Earth Smart Tab shows a visual representation of the estimated energy and paper  
savings based on the selections made.  
Default Earth Smart PC Driver Print Settings  
Printer  
2-Sided  
N-Up  
Skip Blank Pages  
Toner Save  
WorkCentre 3215NI  
WorkCentre 3225DN  
WorkCentre 3225DNI  
Not available  
2Up  
2Up  
2Up  
On  
On  
Long Edge  
Long Edge  
On  
On  
On  
On  
Default Earth Smart Copy Settings  
Printer  
2-Sided  
N-Up  
Skip Blank Pages  
Toner Save  
WorkCentre 3215NI  
WorkCentre 3225DN  
WorkCentre 3225DNI  
Not available  
2Up  
2Up  
2Up  
Not available  
Not available  
Not available  
Not available  
Not available  
Not available  
Long Edge  
Long Edge  
Selecting the EarthSmart On-forced Option in CWIS  
The On-forced option, available via CWIS, allows an administrator to prevent user changes to the  
Earth Smart settings.  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter on your keyboard.  
3. Select Login at the top of the CentreWare Internet Services screen.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing using Windows  
4. Enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
5. Select Earth Smart OFF (or ON) at the top of the screen to access Earth Smart.  
6. In the Earth Smart Mode dialog, select On-forced.  
7. Enter the Password.  
8. Select Apply.  
9. Select OK.  
Xerox Tab  
This tab provides version and copyright information as well as links to drivers and downloads, supplies  
ordering, and the Xerox Web site.  
106  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Xerox Easy Printer Manager (EPM)  
Xerox Easy Printer Manager (EPM)  
Xerox Easy Printer Manager is a Windows-based application that combines Xerox machine settings  
into one location. Xerox Easy Printer Manager conveniently combines device settings as well as  
printing/scanning environments, settings/actions, Scan to PC, and Fax to PC. All of these features  
provide a gateway to conveniently use Xerox devices.  
Xerox Easy Printer Manager installs automatically during driver installation.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing Using Macintosh  
Printing Using Macintosh  
This section explains how to print using a Macintosh. You need to set the print environment before  
printing. Refer to Installation and Setup.  
Printing a Document  
When you print with a Macintosh, you need to check the printer driver setting in each application you  
use. Follow the steps below to print from a Macintosh.  
1. Open the document you want to print.  
2. Open the File menu and select Page Setup (Document Setup in some applications).  
3. Choose your paper size, orientation, scale, and other options. Make sure that your machine is  
selected and select OK.  
4. Open the File menu and select Print.  
5. Choose the number of copies you want and indicate which pages you want to print.  
6. Select Print.  
Changing Printer Settings  
You can use advanced printing features provided by your machine.  
Open an application and select Print from the File menu. The machine name which appears in the  
printer properties window may differ depending on the machine in use. Except for the name, the  
composition of the printer properties window is similar to the following.  
Note: The setting options may differ depending on the printer and the Macintosh OS version.  
TextEdit  
This option allows you to print a header and footer.  
Print Features  
Set Media Type to correspond to the paper loaded in the tray from which you want to print. This will  
let you get the best quality printout. If you load a different type of print material, select the  
corresponding paper type.  
108  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Printing Using Macintosh  
Layout  
The Layout option provides options to adjust how the document appears on the printed page. You can  
print multiple pages on one sheet of paper.  
Two-Sided: Allows you to print a double -side document.  
Reverse page orientation: Allows you to reverse the page orientation (rotate 180 degrees). For  
example, to print the top of a document on the left edge of the paper, select landscape orientation  
and select Reverse Page Orientation.  
Paper Handling  
This option allows you to to set these basic paper handling specifications: Collate Pages, Pages to  
Print, Page Order, Scale to fit paper size.  
Cover Page  
This option allows you to print a cover page before or after the document.  
Supply Levels  
This option shows the current toner level.  
Graphics  
This option allows you to select the printing resolution. The higher the setting, the sharper the clarity of  
printed characters and graphics. The higher setting also may increase the time it takes to print a  
document.  
Printing Multiple Pages on One Sheet  
You can print more than one page on a single sheet of paper. This feature provides a cost-effective way  
to print draft pages.  
1. Open an application, and select Print from the File menu.  
2. Select Layout from the drop-down list under Pages. In the Pages per Sheet drop-down list, select  
the number of pages you want to print on one sheet of paper.  
3. Select the other options you want to use.  
4. Select Print. The machine prints the selected number of pages you want to print on one sheet of  
paper.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing Using Macintosh  
Two Sided Printing  
You can print on both sides of the paper.  
1. From your Macintosh application, select Print from the File menu.  
2. Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation.  
3. Select On from the Two Sided Printing option.  
4. Select the other options you want to use and select Print.  
Using AirPrint  
AirPrint is a software feature that allows for driverless printing from Apple iOS-based mobile  
devicesand Macintosh OS-based devices. AirPrint-enabled printers let you print directly from a  
Macintosh or from an iPhone, iPad, or iPod touch. For more information, refer to the topic AirPrint in  
Installation and Setup in this user guide.  
Using Google Cloud Print  
Google Cloud Print is a service that allows you to print to a printer using your smart phone, tablet, or  
any other web-connected devices. For more information, refer to the topic Google Cloud Print in  
Installation and Setup in this user guide.  
110  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing Using Linux  
Printing Using Linux  
Printing from Applications  
There are a lot of Linux applications that allow you to print using Common Unix Printing System  
(CUPS). You can print on your machine from any such application.  
1. Open an application, and select Print from the File menu.  
2. Select Print directly using lpr.  
3. In the LPR GUI window, select the machine from the printer list and select Properties.  
4. Change the print job properties using the following four tabs displayed at the top of the window.  
General: This option allows you to change the paper size, the paper type, and the orientation  
of the documents. It enables the duplex feature, adds start and end banners, and changes  
the number of pages per sheet.  
Text: This option allows you to specify the page margins and set the text options, such as  
spacing or columns.  
Graphics: This option allows you to set image options that are used when printing image  
files, such as color options, image size, or image position.  
Advanced: This option allows you to set the print resolution, paper source, and destination.  
5. Select Apply to apply the changes and close the Properties window.  
6. Select OK in the LPR GUI window to start printing.  
The Printing window appears, allowing you to monitor the status of your print job.  
Printing Files  
You can print many different file types on your machine using the standard CUPS utility, directly from  
the command line interface. However, the drivers package replaces the standard lpr tool with a much  
more user-friendly LPR GUI program.  
To print any document file:  
1. Type lpr <file_name> from the Linux shell command line and press Enter. The LPR GUI window  
appears.  
2. When you type only lpr and press Enter, the Select file(s) to print window appears first. Select  
any files you want to print and select Open.  
3. In the LPR GUI window, select your machine from the list, and change the print job properties.  
4. Select OK to start printing.  
Configuring Printer Properties  
Using the Printer Properties window provided by the Printers configuration, you can change the various  
properties for your machine as a printer.  
1. Open the Unified Driver Configurator.  
If necessary, switch to Printers configuration.  
2. Select your machine on the available printers list and select Properties.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Printing Using Linux  
3. The Printer Properties window opens.  
The following five tabs display at the top of the window:  
General: This option allows you to change the printer location and name. The name entered  
in this tab displays on the printer list in Printers configuration.  
Connection: This option allows you to view or select another port. If you change the machine  
port from USB to parallel or vice versa while in use, you must re-configure the machine port in  
this tab.  
Driver: This option allows you to view or select another machine driver. Selecting Options you  
to set the default device options.  
Jobs: This option shows the list of Print jobs. Select Cancel job to cancel the selected job and  
select the Show completed jobs check box to see previous jobs on the job list.  
Classes: This option shows the class that your machine is in. Select Add to Class to add your  
machine to a specific class or select Remove from Class to remove the machine from the  
selected class.  
4. Select OK to apply the changes and close the Printer Properties window.  
112  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing Using Unix  
Printing Using Unix  
Printing Files  
After installing the printer, choose any of the images, text, PS to print.  
1. Execute “printui <file_name_to_print>” command. For example, if you are printing “document1”  
use printui document1 command.  
This will open the Unix printer driver Print Job Manager in which the user can select various print  
options.  
2. Select a printer that has already been added.  
3. Select the printing options from the window such as Page Selection.  
4. Select how many copies are needed in Number of Copies.  
5. Press OK to start the print job.  
Configuring Printer Properties  
The Unix printer driver Print Job Manager allows you to configure various print options using the  
printer Properties option. The following hot keys may also be used: H for Help, O for OK, A for Apply,  
and C for Cancel.  
General Tab  
Paper Size: Set the paper size as A4, Letter, or other paper sizes, according to your requirements.  
Paper Type: Choose the type of the paper. Options available in the list box are Printer Default,  
Plain, and Thick.  
Paper Source: Select from which tray the paper is used. By default, it is Auto Selection.  
Orientation: Select the direction in which information is printed on a page.  
Duplex: Print on both sides of paper to save paper.  
Multiple pages: Print several pages on one side of the paper.  
Page Border: Choose any of the border styles (e.g., Single-line hairline, Double-line hairline)  
Image Tab  
In this tab, you can change the brightness, resolution, or image position of your document.  
Text Tab  
Use this tab to set the character margin, line space, or the columns of the actual print output.  
Margins Tab  
Use Margins: Set the margins for the document. By default, margins are not enabled. The user  
can change the margin settings by changing the values in the respective fields. Set by default,  
these values depend on the page size selected.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Printing Using Unix  
Unit: Change the units to points, inches, or centimeters.  
Printer-Specific Settings Tab  
Select various options in the JCL and General frames to customize various settings. These options are  
specific to the printer and depend on the PPD file.  
114  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copy  
5
This chapter includes:  
Copy Procedure  
Copy Options  
Using the Layout Options  
Media Output Locations  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copy Procedure  
Copy Procedure  
This section describes the basic procedure for making copies:  
Load Documents  
Select the Features  
Enter the Quantity  
Start the Job  
Stop the Copy Job  
If an authentication feature is enabled, you may need an account before using the machine. To get an  
account, or for more information, contact your System Administrator.  
Load Documents  
Documents can be loaded either into the automatic document feeder or onto the platen glass.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
Automatic Document Feeder  
The automatic document feeder can hold a maximum of 40 originals of 20 lb (80 g/m²) thickness.  
1. Load documents to be scanned face up in the input tray  
of the automatic document feeder with the top of the  
document to the left of the tray.  
2. Move the document guide to just touch both sides of the  
document.  
116  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copy Procedure  
Platen Glass  
The platen glass can be used for oversized, torn, or damaged originals, and for books and magazines.  
1. Open the automatic document feeder and place single  
documents face down on the platen glass aligned with  
the rear left corner.  
2. The default document size is 8.5 x 11” or A4. For other  
sized documents, change the Original Size option. For  
more information, refer to Copy Options.  
Select the Features  
Various features can be selected for your copy job. Copy options are available through the Menu  
button. Once you have made a selection, press Back to return to the Ready screen.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
1. Press Copy on the control panel.  
The paper tray is the default paper supply. Open  
the manual feed slot to feed individual types of  
stock, for example, letterhead or labels for  
one-off jobs. For more information, refer to Paper  
and Media.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to display the desired  
feature and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to display the desired option and press OK to save your selections. For  
more information about programming options, refer to Copy Options.  
5. Press Back to return to the top level menu.  
Enter the Quantity  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
The maximum copy quantity is 99.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copy Procedure  
Use the keypad or the up/down arrows on the control panel to enter the number of copies  
required. The number entered is displayed in the lower right-hand corner of the display.  
Note: To cancel an incorrect entry, press Clear All and enter the correct quantity.  
Start the Job  
1. Press Start. Each document is scanned only once.  
2. If using the document glass to scan 1-2 sided originals, the machine displays a message when  
ready to scan side 2. Continue scanning until all sides have been scanned.  
The images are scanned and the copy job is printed.  
Stop the Copy Job  
To cancel an active copy job, on the control panel, press Stop.  
118  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copy Options  
Copy Options  
Your machine provides the following options to customize your Copy jobs. Use the Menu button to  
access the options.  
Notes:  
Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
If you press Clear All while setting the Copy options, all of the options you have set for  
the current Copy job will be canceled and return to their default status after the machine  
completes the Copy job in progress.  
Feature  
Description  
Options  
Original Size  
Allows you to specify the  
size of the image to be  
scanned.  
A4  
A5  
B5 (JIS)  
Letter  
Executive  
Folio (available only when an original is in the ADF)  
Legal (available only when an original is in the ADF)  
Reduce/Enlarge  
Originals can be reduced  
or enlarged between 25%  
and 400%.  
100 %: Produces an image on the copies the same size  
as the image on the original.  
Presets: The 9 most commonly used reduce/enlarge  
percentages have been provided as preset options.  
These preset options can be customized by your  
System or Machine Administrator to meet individual  
needs.  
Auto Fit: Reduces or enlarges the image on the copies  
based on the size of the original and the size of the  
selected output paper.  
Custom. Use the keypad or the up/down arrows to  
enter the percentage required.  
2 Sided  
Select the required 2 Sided option using the up/down  
arrows and press OK.  
1
1 Sided: Use this option for 1 sided originals  
when 1 sided copies are required.  
2 Sided: Use this option for 1 sided originals  
when 2 sided copies are required.  
2 Sided, Rotate Side 2: This option produces 2  
1
1
sided copies from 1 sided originals and rotates 180  
degrees every second side image. Use this option to  
create documents which can be read in a head to toe  
manner, for example, a calendar.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copy Options  
Feature  
Description  
Options  
Lighten/Darken  
Adjusts the lightness or  
darkness of the output.  
Lighten +1 to +5: Lightens the image in increments to  
the lightest setting of Lighten +5; works well with dark  
print.  
Normal: Works well with standard typed or printed  
originals.  
Darken +1 to +5: Darkens the original in increments  
to the darkest setting of Darken +5; works well with  
light print.  
Original Type  
The Original Type setting  
is used to improve the  
image quality by selecting  
the document type for the  
originals.  
Text: Use for originals containing mostly text.  
Text/Photo: Use for originals with mixed text and  
photographs.  
Photo: Use when the originals are photographs.  
Collation  
Layout  
Places printed pages in  
order.  
On: Defines the page sequence for printing.  
Off: Select if collation is not required.  
This option is used to copy  
multiple documents onto  
one sheet of paper, copy  
from book originals, create  
booklet output, and  
produce documents which  
can be pasted together to  
make a poster.  
Normal: Select this option to match the layout of the  
originals.  
2 Up: This feature is used to copy two documents, in a  
reduced size, onto one sheet of paper.  
4 Up: This feature is used to copy four documents, in a  
reduced size, onto one sheet of paper.  
ID Card Copy: The machine prints one side of the  
original on the upper half of the paper and the other  
side on the lower half without reducing the size of the  
original.  
Refer to Using the Layout Options for instructions.  
Adjust Bkgd.  
Use to print an image  
without its background.  
This feature reduces or  
eliminates the dark  
background resulting from  
scanning colored paper or  
newspaper originals.  
Off: Select if Background Adjustment is not required.  
Auto: Select to optimize the background.  
Enhance Lev 1 - 2: Select a higher number for a more  
vivid background.  
Erase Lev. 1-4: Select a higher number for a lighter  
background.  
120  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Layout Options  
Using the Layout Options  
This option is used to copy multiple documents onto one sheet of paper, copy from book originals,  
create booklet output, and produce documents which can be pasted together to make a poster.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
2 Up or 4 Up Copying  
This feature is used to copy two or more documents, in a  
reduced size, onto one sheet of paper. It is ideal for creating  
handouts, storyboards, or documents used for archival  
purposes.  
Note: Originals must be loaded in the automatic  
document feeder when using this feature.  
1. Press Copy on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to display Layout and press OK.  
4. Select the option required:  
Normal: Copies an original onto one sheet of paper.  
2 Up: Copies two separate originals onto one sheet of paper.  
4 Up: Copies four separate originals onto one sheet of paper.  
Note: For landscape originals, place the top of the document at the back of the feeder. For portrait  
originals, place the top of the document to the left.  
5. Select OK to save your selections and press Back to return to the top level menu.  
6. Load originals and press Start.  
ID Copy  
The machine prints one side of the original on the upper half  
of the paper and the other side on the lower half without  
reducing the size of the original. This feature is helpful for  
copying a small-sized item, such as a business card.  
Note: This Copy feature is available only when you place  
originals on the platen glass. If the original is larger than  
the printable area, some portions may not be printed.  
Your machine can print 2 sided originals on one sheet of A4,  
Letter, Legal, Folio, Executive, B5, A5, or A6 paper.  
1. Press Copy on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Layout and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select ID Card Copy and press OK.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using the Layout Options  
5. Press Menu to return to the top level menu.  
6. Place the front side of the original face down on the  
platen glass, aligned with the tip of the registration  
arrow and close the automatic document feeder.  
7. Press Start.  
Place Front Side Press OK appears on the display. Press  
OK on the control panel.  
Your machine begins scanning the front side and shows  
Place Rear Side Press Start.  
8. Turn the original over and place the rear side of the  
original face down on the platen glass and close the  
automatic document feeder.  
9. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
122  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Media Output Locations  
Media Output Locations  
The machine has two output locations:  
Output tray, face down, up to a maximum of 120 sheets  
of 20 lb (80 g/m²) paper.  
Rear cover, face up, one sheet at a time.  
The machine sends output to the output tray by default. If special media, such as envelopes, print out  
with wrinkles, curl, creases, or black bold lines, the rear cover should be used for the output. Open the  
rear cover and keep it open while printing one sheet at a time.  
Note: The rear cover output can only be used for simplex jobs. Duplex printing with the rear door  
open will cause paper jams.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Media Output Locations  
Using the Output Tray  
The output tray collects printed paper face down, in the order in which the sheets were printed. The  
output tray should be used for most jobs. When the output tray is full, a message displays on the  
control panel.  
To use the output tray, make sure that the rear cover is closed.  
Notes:  
If paper coming out of the output tray has problems, such as excessive curl, try printing  
to the rear cover.  
To reduce paper jams, do not open or close the rear cover while the printer is printing.  
Using the Rear Cover  
When using the rear cover, paper comes out of the machine  
face up. Printing from the bypass tray to the rear cover  
provides a straight paper path and might improve the output  
quality when printing on envelopes or special media.  
Whenever the rear cover is open, the output is delivered there.  
Note: The rear cover output can only be used for simplex  
jobs. Duplex printing with the rear cover open causes  
paper jams.  
CAUTION: The fuser area inside the rear cover of your  
machine becomes very hot when in use. Take care when  
you access this area.  
124  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Scan  
6
This chapter includes:  
Scanning Overview  
Windows Scanning  
Macintosh Scanning  
Linux Scanning  
Scan Using TWAIN  
Scan using WIA Driver  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scanning Overview  
Scanning Overview  
The Scan feature enables users to create a digital version of a hard copy document which can be sent  
to a computer over the network or through a USB connection. The document can be scanned in color,  
grayscale, or black and white, and the digital file can then be sent to a specified destination.  
Before you begin the scan process, ensure that your machine has been set up for the scan function at  
install. For instructions on setting up and configuring the Scan function, refer to Installation and Setup.  
This section provides instructions for scanning to a PC/network using one of three operating systems:  
Windows, Macintosh, or Linux. Follow the directions for the operating system appropriate to your  
computer system.  
The following options are available from the Scan button on the control panel:  
Scan to PC: You can scan a document to a PC connected to the device in one of two ways:  
Local PC: For scanning to a PC connected directly to the WorkCentre 3215/3225 via a USB  
cable. For Windows scanning, the Printer Driver with Easy Printer Manager must be installed  
on your PC prior to use. For Macintosh scanning, the Printer Driver with Image Capture or  
Xerox Scan Assistant must be installed.  
Network PC: Use this option to scan data to a networked PC. For Windows, the Printer Driver  
with Easy Printer Manager must be installed on your PC prior to use. For Macintosh scanning,  
the Printer Driver with Image Capture or Xerox Scan Assistant must be installed.  
Web Services for Devices (WSD): Use this option to scan to applications or computers that  
support Microsoft's Web Services for Devices. This option was designed for Windows Vista and  
also works with Windows 7 and Windows 8. The WSD process initiates a scan and forwards it to an  
address designated by the Windows event, from your PC or from the machine.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
Scan Process  
The basic procedure for scanning using a PC connected to the WorkCentre 3215/3225 is:  
At your computer:  
Ensure that the scan function is enabled at the WC3215/3225 and has established a connection  
with your computer  
At the Xerox machine:  
Load the documents  
At the Xerox machine OR at your computer  
Select the scan connection type: Local PC, Network PC, or WSD (Windows only)  
Select the scan destination  
Select the scan job features  
Start the job  
If necessary, stop the job.  
126  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Scanning Overview  
Scanning Methods  
Your machine offers the following ways to scan an image using a local connection:  
TWAIN: TWAIN drivers handle the communication between computer software and the scanning  
device. This feature can be used via a local connection or a network connection in various  
operating systems. Refer to Scan Using TWAIN.  
WIA (Windows Image Acquisition): To use this feature your computer must be connected to the  
machine via a USB cable and running Windows Vista or Windows 7. Refer to Scan Using WIA  
Driver.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Windows Scanning  
Windows Scanning  
Process Checklist  
Ensure the Scan function has been set up for your machine. See Installation and Setup for further  
details.  
Ensure Xerox Easy Printer Manager application is installed. This application is provided with the  
Xerox WC3215/3225 printer driver. Easy Printer Manager is an easy way to choose scan settings  
and manage machine operations.  
Once you have enabled the Scan function and set up your Scan settings, any scan job can be  
initiated from your computer or the Xerox machine once the original is placed in the scanner or  
ADF.  
If an authentication or security feature is enabled, you may need an account before using the  
machine. To get an account, or for more information, contact the System Administrator.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration and the Scan  
features and destination selected.  
Enable Scan to PC  
1. At your computer, open the Xerox Easy Printer Manager application: Open the Start menu, select  
Programs or All Programs, select Xerox Printers, select Xerox Easy Printer Manager.  
2. At the top of the Easy Printer Manager window, select the Switch to Advanced Mode button.  
3. Select the Scan to PC Settings button at top of window.The Scan to PC Settings screen appears.  
4. Select Enable Scan from Device Panel.  
5. Select the scan features you will use in scanning to the machine in Scan Settings:  
Output Color  
Resolution  
Original Size  
6. Select your File Settings:  
Save to: where on your computer you want your scanned file to be saved  
File Format  
Actions after Saving: notification when scanning complete and other options.  
7. Click the Image tab to make further feature selections for Scan Settings.  
8. Select Save at the bottom of screen to save your scan and file settings.  
Note: You can also select Default to set the machine to scan using the default settings.  
Note: These settings will be confirmed at the machine when you send the fax from the control  
panel.  
128  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Windows Scanning  
Load Documents  
Documents can be loaded either into the automatic document feeder or onto the platen glass.  
Automatic Document Feeder  
The automatic document feeder can hold a maximum of 40 originals of 20 lb (80 g/m²) thickness.  
1. Load documents to be scanned face up in the input tray of the automatic document feeder with  
the top of the document to the left of the tray.  
2. Move the document guide to just touch both sides of the document.  
Platen Glass  
The platen glass can be used for oversized, torn, or damaged originals and for books and magazines.  
1. Open the automatic document feeder and place single  
documents face down on the platen glass aligned with the  
rear left corner.  
2. The default document size is 8.5 x 11” or A4 (depending on  
the country of installation). For other sized documents,  
change the Original Size option. Refer to Scan Options for  
further information.  
Select the Scan Destination  
When you select the Scan button on the left side of the control  
panel, two options appear in the user interface: Scan to PC and  
Scan to WSD.  
When you select Scan to PC, you must choose the type of connection: Local or Network PC.  
Note: If a computer is not connected to the machine via the USB port, the Scan to Local PC option  
will not appear in the user interface. Once you connect a computer to the machine via the USB,  
that option for scanning will appear.  
Note: If you have not set up scan in Easy Printer Manager from your PC, your PC will not appear as  
a destination in the Scan Menu at the machine.  
Scan to Local PC  
To use Scan to Local PC, the machine must be connected to your PC or workstation via a USB cable. The  
scan driver must be installed on your PC prior to use. For driver installation instructions, refer to the  
Installation and Setup section.  
1. Press the Scan button on the control panel.  
2. Scan to PC appears in the user interface. Press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Local PC.  
4. Press OK. If you see the Not Available message, check the port connection and/or scan setup.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select the scan destination you want and press OK.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Windows Scanning  
Scan to Network PC  
Make sure that your machine is connected to a network. Make sure the scan driver has been installed  
and scan has been enabled. For instructions, see Installation and Setup.  
1. Press Scan on the control panel.  
2. Scan to PC appears in the user interface. Press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Network PC.  
4. Press OK. If you see the Not Available message, check the connection and/or setup.  
5. In the Destination List that appears, press the up/down arrows to find the name of the computer  
that you want to receive the scan and press OK.  
Scan to WSD  
Using this option you can scan to applications or computers that support Microsoft's Web Services for  
Devices.  
1. Press Scan on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select WSD and press OK.  
3. Scroll until the Destination you want appears and press OK.  
4. At the Profile List prompt, which is confirming where you want your scan file stored on your  
computer, press the up/down arrows to select the correct location/event profile and press OK.  
Select the Features  
Once you have selected the mode of connection, you can select the features needed for your scan job.  
Note: Some of the following options may be unavailable depending on your machine  
configuration and the scan method selected.  
5. The following features are available through the machine’s Menu button for Scan to Local PC and  
Scan to Network PC, and also in your computer’s Scan interface for each operating system.  
Output Color  
Resolution  
Sets the color mode of the scanned image: Color, Grayscale, or Black and  
White.  
Sets the image resolution: 100 dpi, 200 dpi, 300 dpi or 600 dpi. A higher  
resolution increases the file size.  
Original Size  
File Format  
Set the size of the original(s) being scanned: Letter, Executive, A4, A5, B5  
(JIS).  
Sets the file format of the saved image: Multi-page PDF, Single-page  
PDF, Multi-page TIFF, Single-page TIFF, JPEG.  
At the machine’s user interface, scroll until the feature you want appears and then press OK. Select  
the setting required and press OK.  
130  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Windows Scanning  
Start the Job  
Once you have placed the document you wish to scan and chosen the job features, you can initiate the  
scan at either the machine or your PC.  
1. Press the Start button at the machine OR at your PC.  
2. Your machine begins scanning the original, and then asks if you want to scan another page.  
3. To scan another page, press the up/down arrows to select Yes and press OK. Load an original and  
press Start. Otherwise, select No and press OK.  
The images are scanned and sent to the destination selected in the job.  
Stop the Job  
To cancel an active Scan job.  
1. Press the Stop button on the control panel. The machine will stop scanning and delete the file and  
the job, and move on to the next job.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Macintosh Scanning  
Macintosh Scanning  
This section describes the basic procedure for scanning using a Macintosh computer running Mac OS X  
10.5 or later:  
Load Documents  
Select the Scan Destination  
Select the Features  
Start the Job  
Stop a Job (if necessary).  
Process Checklist  
Ensure the Scan function has been set up for your Xerox machine. See Installation and Setup for  
further details.  
Determine which application you will use to scan your documents. Ensure the application is loaded  
on your Macintosh computer and ready to use.  
Image Capture is a Macintosh application that provides an easy way to choose scan settings  
and perform a scan job.  
Scan Assistant is a Xerox utility that is automatically installed with the your Xerox Printer  
Driver. It provides an interface to select a scanner and to adjust Scan settings and start the  
scanning process directly from your computer.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration and the Scan  
features and destination selected.  
Load Documents  
Documents can be loaded either into the automatic document feeder or onto the platen glass.  
Automatic Document Feeder  
The automatic document feeder can hold a maximum of 40 originals of 20 lb (80 g/m²) thickness.  
1. Load documents to be scanned face up in the input tray of the automatic document feeder with  
the top of the document to the left of the tray.  
2. Move the document guide to just touch both sides of the document.  
132  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Macintosh Scanning  
Platen Glass  
The platen glass can be used for oversized, torn, or damaged originals and for books and magazines.  
1. Open the automatic document feeder and place single  
documents face down on the platen glass aligned with  
the rear left corner.  
2. The default document size is 8.5 x 11” or A4 (depending  
on the country of installation). For other sized  
documents, change the Original Size option. Refer to  
Scan Options for further information.  
Enable Scan to PC  
1. At your Macintosh computer, open the Applications  
folder and click Image Capture.  
Note: The following steps might vary, depending on your  
Mac OS version. These steps are for Mac OS 10.8. but  
may work in other versions, including 10.6 and later.  
2. Find your device in the list in left column and click on it.  
3. Select the features for the scan job from the Scan Menu on the right side of screen.  
4. Set the scan options for your scan jobs by pressing Save.  
Note: These settings will be confirmed at the machine when you send the fax from the control  
panel.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Macintosh Scanning  
Image Capture Scan Options  
Scan Job Features  
Scan Mode  
Settings  
Flatbed: From the platen glass  
Document Feeder  
Kind  
Text  
Black and White  
Color  
Resolution  
Size  
75 dpi - 600 dpi  
A4, Letter, Legal  
Orientation  
Portrait, Landscape, Reversed Portrait, Reversed  
Landscape  
Scan To  
Desktop  
Documents folder  
[Other folder names on device]  
Name  
Create a name for the scanned file  
Format  
JPEG, TIFF, PNG, JPEG 2000, GIF, BMP, PDF  
Image Correction  
None  
Manual: Brightness, Tint, Temperature, Saturation  
Restore Defaults  
134  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Macintosh Scanning  
Select the Scan Destination  
When you press the Scan button on the left side of the control panel, two options appear in the user  
interface: Scan to PC and Scan to WSD.  
When you select Scan to PC, you must choose the type of connection: Local or Network PC.  
Note: If a computer is not connected to the machine via the USB port, the Scan to Local PC option  
will not appear in the user interface. Once you connect a computer to the machine via the USB,  
that option for scanning will appear.  
Note: If you have not set up enabled scanning to the Xerox machine from your computer, your  
Mac will not appear as a destination in the Scan Menu at the machine.  
Scan to Local PC  
To use Scan to Local PC, the machine must be connected to your PC or workstation via a USB cable. The  
scan driver must be installed on your PC prior to use. For driver installation instructions, refer to the  
Installation and Setup section.  
At the machine:  
1. Press Scan button on the control panel.  
2. Scan to PC appears in the user interface. Press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Local PC.  
4. Press OK. If you see the Not Available message, check the port connection and/or scan setup.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select the scan destination you want and press OK.  
Scan to Network PC  
At the machine:  
1. Press Scan on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to select Scan to PC.  
3. Press OK. If you see the Not Available message, check the connection and/or setup.  
4. In the Destination List that appears, press the up/down arrows to find the name of the computer  
which you want to receive the scan and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select the Scan Destination you want and press OK.  
6. Scroll through the Scan features to ensure they are the settings you need for the scan job: the  
Profile List, File Format, Output Color, Resolution, and Original size settings. If not, change the  
settings as needed. Press OK.  
Start the Job  
Once you have placed the document you want to scan and chosen the job features, you can initiate the  
scan at either the machine or your PC.  
1. Press the Start button at the machine OR select Scan in Image Capture at your computer.  
2. Your machine begins scanning the original, and then asks if you want to scan another page.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Macintosh Scanning  
3. To scan another page, press the up/down arrows to select Yes and press OK. Load an original and  
press Start. Otherwise, select No and press OK.  
The images are scanned and sent to the destination selected in the job.  
Note: If scanning does not operate in Image Capture, update Mac OS to the latest version.  
Image Capture operates correctly in Mac OS X 10.4.7 or higher.  
Stop the Job  
To cancel an active Scan job.  
1. Press the Stop button on the control panel. The machine will stop scanning and delete the file and  
the job, and move on to the next job.  
136  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Linux Scanning  
Linux Scanning  
You can scan a document using the Unified Driver Configurator window. Make sure that the machine is  
powered on and connected to your computer via USB cable, or connected to the network. Install the  
scan driver. Follow the install instructions provided with your driver.  
Scanning  
1. Double-click the Unified Driver Configurator on your desktop.  
2. Click the button to switch to Scanners Configuration.  
3. Select the scanner in the list.  
If you use only one machine device and it is connected to the computer and turned on, your  
scanner appears in the list and is automatically selected.  
If you have two or more scanners connected to your computer, you can select any scanner to  
work at any time. For example, while acquisition is in progress on the first scanner, you may  
select the second scanner, set the device options, and start the image acquisition  
simultaneously.  
4. Click Properties.  
5. Load originals face up into the automatic document feeder, or place a single original face down on  
the platen glass.  
6. From the Scanner Properties window, click Preview.  
The document is scanned and the image preview appears in the Preview Pane.  
7. Drag the pointer to set the image area to be scanned in the Preview Pane.  
8. Change the scan options in the Image Quality and Scan Area sections.  
Image Quality: This option allows you to select the color composition and the scan  
resolution for the image.  
Scan Area: This option allows you to select the page size. The Advanced button enables you  
to set the page size manually.  
If you want to use one of the preset scan option settings, select the option from the Job Type  
drop-down list.  
9. Click Default to restore the default setting for the scan options.  
10. When you have finished, click Scan to start scanning.  
The status bar appears on the bottom left of the window to show you the progress of the scan. To  
cancel scanning, click Cancel.  
The scanned image appears.  
11. When you are finished, click Save on the toolbar.  
12. Select the file directory where you want to save the image and enter the file name.  
13. Click Save.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Linux Scanning  
Job Type Settings  
You can save your scan option settings for later use.  
Saving a New Job Type Setting  
1. Change the options from the Scanner Properties window.  
2. Click Save As.  
3. Enter the name for your setting.  
4. Click OK.  
Your setting is added to the Job Type drop-down list.  
Deleting a Job Type Setting  
1. Select the setting you want to delete from the Job Type drop-down list.  
2. Click Delete.  
The setting is deleted from the list.  
Using the Image Manager  
The Image Manager application provides you with menu commands and tools to edit your scanned  
image. Use the following tools to edit the image:  
Tools  
Name  
Function  
Save  
Saves the image.  
Undo  
Redo  
Cancels your last action.  
Restores the action you canceled.  
Scroll  
Crop  
Allows you to scroll through the image.  
Crops the selected image area.  
Zoom Out  
Zoom In  
Zooms the image out.  
Zooms the image in.  
Scale  
Allows you to scale the image size; you can enter the size manually, or  
set the rate to scale proportionally, vertically, or horizontally.  
138  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Linux Scanning  
Tools  
Name  
Function  
Rotate  
Allows you to rotate the image; you can select the number of degrees  
from the drop-down list.  
Flip  
Allows you to flip the image vertically or horizontally.  
Effect  
Allows you to adjust the brightness or contrast of the image, or to invert  
the image.  
Properties  
Shows the properties of the image.  
For further details about the Image Manager application, refer to the on screen help.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scan Using TWAIN  
Scan Using TWAIN  
If you want to scan documents using other software, you will need to use TWAIN compliant software,  
such as Adobe Photoshop. Follow the steps below to scan with TWAIN compliant software.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on.  
2. Install the TWAIN driver. Follow the install instructions provided with your driver.  
3. Load originals face up into the automatic document feeder, or place a single original face down on  
the platen glass.  
4. Open an application, such as Adobe Photoshop.  
5. Open the TWAIN window and set the scan options.  
6. Scan and save your scanned image.  
140  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scan Using WIA Driver  
Scan Using WIA Driver  
Your machine also supports the Windows Image Acquisition (WIA) driver for scanning images. WIA is  
one of the standard components provided by Microsoft Windows and works with digital cameras and  
scanners.  
Note: For this machine, the WIA driver works only on Windows Vista/7.0/8.0 with a USB port.  
1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on.  
2. Install the WIA driver. Follow the install instructions provided with your Xerox machine’s driver.  
3. Load originals face up into the automatic document feeder, or place a single original face down on  
the platen glass.  
4. Scan the originals using the following instructions:  
Windows Vista  
a. From the Start menu, select Control Panel > Scanners and Cameras.  
b. Double-click Scan a document or picture. The Windows Fax and Scan application appears.  
You can select View scanners and cameras to view the scanners.  
c. If there is no Scan a document or picture instruction visible, open the MS Paint program and  
from the File menu click From Scanner or Camera.  
d. Select New Scan. The scan driver displays. Choose your scanning preferences.  
e. Select Scan.  
Windows 7  
a. From the Start menu, select Control Panel > Devices and Printers.  
b. Click the right mouse button on the device driver icon in Printers and Faxes > Start Scan.  
New Scan application appears.  
c. Choose your scanning preferences.  
d. Select Scan.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scan Using WIA Driver  
142  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax  
7
This chapter includes:  
Overview  
Fax Send Procedure  
Fax Send Options  
Fax Receive Options  
Fax Forward Sent/Received Feature  
Fax from PC  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Overview  
Overview  
Your Xerox multifunction machine offers a wide selection of Fax capabilities and features. This section  
provides instruction on how to use them effectively.  
Before you begin any of the processes in this section, check that the Fax functionality was set up at  
installation and the communications pathways enabled. See Installation and Setup for further  
information.  
Changing Fax Defaults Using CentreWare Internet Services  
During machine installation and setup, Default settings were established for the machine functions,  
including Fax. To change one or more of these Fax settings after install, go to either Easy Printer  
Manager or CentreWare Internet Services, following the instructions below.  
1. For CentreWare: At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the  
machine in the Address Bar. Press Enter.  
If you don’t know the IP address, go to your Easy Printer Manager (in your Start menu) and select  
the printer for which you are changing features. When the printer page opens, click on Machine  
Settings tab. You will be redirected to CentreWare Internet Services. Follow the steps below to  
complete this process.  
2. At the CentreWare page for your machine, select Properties.  
3. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select  
Login. Click Properties.  
4. In the Machine Settings link, select the Fax link on the left navigation pane.  
5. Select the General link on the left navigation pane.  
6. In the Change Default area, for the features listed, the setting shown is the machine default. If  
you would like to change your machine’s default for any setting, click on the pull-down menu and  
choose the feature setting you want.  
Note: Users can change these feature settings in any fax job; once the job is over, the machine  
goes back to the Default setting.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
144  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax Procedure: Sending a Fax  
Fax Procedure: Sending a Fax  
This section describes the basic procedure for sending a fax. Follow the steps below to send a fax.  
Load the Documents  
Select the Features  
Enter the Fax Number  
Start the Job  
Check the Job Status  
To Stop a Fax Job  
Fax Confirmation  
Note: Refer to Installation and Setup for information on setting up the Fax function.  
Load the Documents  
Documents can be loaded either into the automatic document feeder (ADF) or onto the document  
glass. If there are documents in both, those in the ADF will be scanned first.  
Automatic Document Feeder  
The automatic document feeder can hold a maximum of 40 originals of 20 lb (80 g/m²) thickness.  
1. Load documents to be scanned face up in the input tray of the automatic document feeder with  
the top of the document to the left of the tray.  
2. Adjust the document guides if necessary so that they just touch both sides of the document.  
Platen Glass  
The platen glass can be used for oversized, torn, or damaged originals and for books and magazines.  
1. Open the automatic document feeder and place single  
documents face down on the platen glass aligned with the rear  
left corner.  
2. The default document size is 8.5 x 11” or A4 (depending on the  
country). For other sized documents, be sure to change the  
Original Size option when programming the job.  
Note: Documents are only scanned once even when several  
destinations or copies are selected.  
Once you have placed the documents you want to fax in the machine,  
you can program the rest of the fax job from the machine or from your  
computer using Easy Printer Manager or CentreWare Internet Services.  
See below for steps for each method.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax Procedure: Sending a Fax  
Select the Features  
Fax features can be selected for each fax job. They were set up at installation of the machine as  
defaults; if you want to change those defaults for a particular job, follow the steps below. If you want  
to use the default settings for image quality, resolution, and original size, and are sending a basic fax to  
one location, you can skip this step. After the fax job, the machine will return to the default settings.  
You can choose the fax features needed for your fax job by following these steps.  
From the Machine:  
1. Press the Fax button.  
2. Press the Menu button.  
3. Using the up/down arrows, select the Fax Features menu.  
4. Scroll through the features and select the settings required for your  
fax job.  
5. To select a feature, press OK.  
6. Then scroll to find the option you need within that feature or to select Yes or No. Press OK. The  
machine will respond that the feature has been saved for that job.  
7. Press the Back button to return to the Features menu and continue selecting features for the job.  
8. When you have selected all the features for your job, press OK.  
The following Fax Features are available through the Menu button.  
Lighten/Darken  
Resolution  
This provides manual control to adjust the lightness or darkness of the  
scanned images.  
A higher resolution produces better quality for photos. A lower resolution  
reduces communication time.  
Original Size  
Multi Send  
Delay Send  
Priority Send  
This option allows you to specify the size of the image to be scanned.  
You can use this feature to send a fax to multiple locations.  
Use to set your machine to send a fax at a later time.  
Use when a high priority fax need to be sent ahead of reserved  
operations.  
Forward Send/Receive  
Secure Receive  
Add Page  
You can set the machine to forward a received or sent fax to another fax  
or to a networked PC.  
Use to restrict printing of received faxes when the machine is  
unattended.  
Use to add additional documents to a delayed fax job which is saved in  
memory.  
Cancel Job  
Cancel a delayed fax stored in the machine’s memory.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fax Procedure: Sending a Fax  
From Your Computer:  
From CentreWare: At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the  
machine in the Address Bar. Press Enter. From the CentreWare Internet Services page for your  
machine, select Properties, then General, then Fax. Make the changes needed to each feature.  
Click Apply when you are done.  
From Easy Printer Manager: Open Easy Printer Manager in your Start menu. Select the printer for  
which you are changing features. When the printer page opens, click on Machine Settings tab.  
You will be redirected to CentreWare Internet Services. Follow the steps below to complete this  
process.  
Enter the Fax Number  
1. The UI on the control panel should say  
Fax 1: _____  
2. Enter the recipient’s fax number by:  
a. Keypad Dial: Enter the number using the keypad when the machine prompt Fax 1:____  
displays.  
b. Manual Dial: Press the On Hook button to hear a dial tone before entering the fax number.  
c. Redial: Press the Redial button on the right side of the control panel to automatically dial the  
last fax number (or numbers) used. Scroll through the list to select the number.  
d. Speed Dial: For a one-digit (0-9) speed dial number, press and hold the corresponding digit  
button on the keypad. For a two or three-digit speed dial number, press the first digit  
button(s) and then hold down the last digit button.  
e. Address Book: Select the Address Book button to access the address book and select a  
Speed Dial or Group Dial entry to add to the recipient list. Refer to Address Book section for  
instructions on setting up and using the Address Book.  
Start the Job  
1. At the machine, press the Start button. (For initiating a fax job from your PC, see Fax from PC.)  
2. The machine scans the originals, dials the entered number(s), and attempts to connect with the  
remote fax machine. Once connected, the machine sends the fax job.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
147  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax Procedure: Sending a Fax  
If the number you have dialed is busy or there is no answer when you send a fax, the machine  
automatically redials the number every three minutes, up to seven times according to the factory  
default settings.  
Note: Your machine’s default setting may have been changed during installation and setup. You  
can change it now if you wish by following these steps.  
To change the time interval between redials and the number of redial attempts:  
a. Select Machine Status button, then scroll to Fax Setup. Press OK.  
b. Scroll to Sending. Press OK.  
c. Scroll to Redial Times. Press OK. Set the number of times you want the machine to redial to  
attempt to send the fax. You can choose up to 13 times. Press OK.  
d. Scroll to Redial Term. Press OK. Set the number of minutes between redial attempts. You can  
set it for up to 15 minutes between redials. Press OK.  
e. If the display shows Retry Redial? press OK to redial the number without waiting. To cancel  
the automatic redialing, press Stop.  
f. To get confirmation that the fax was sent, follow the steps below to print a confirmation  
report.  
Fax Confirmation  
When the last page of your original has been sent successfully, the machine beeps and returns to  
Ready mode.  
To print a confirmation report for the last fax sent, follow these steps:  
Press the Machine Status button.  
Scroll to Info Pages and press OK.  
Scroll to Fax Confirm and press OK.  
Scroll to Print. Press OK to print a Confirmation page that includes a reduced image of the  
first page of the fax.  
When initiating a Fax from your PC, a message may appear on your PC after the fax has been  
delivered to its destination, if you selected Notify me of delivery on the Fax options page,  
depending on the application and operating system. From Easy Printer Manager, you can also opt  
to have an email sent to you confirming that your fax job was completed.  
If something goes wrong while sending your fax, an error message appears on the display. If you  
receive an error message, press Stop to clear the message, fix the problem, and try to send the fax  
again. For further assistance, see Fax Problems.  
You can also set your machine to print a confirmation report automatically each time a fax is sent.  
Press the Machine Status button, then scroll to System Setup. Press OK.  
Scroll to Machine Setup. Press OK.  
Scroll to Confirm. Press OK.  
To Stop a Fax Job  
To cancel an active fax job, press the red Stop button on the control panel.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
148  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax Procedure: Sending a Fax  
To cancel a Delayed Fax job follow these steps:  
1. Press the Fax button on the control panel.  
2. Press the Menu button. Scroll to Fax Feature. Press OK.  
3. Scroll to Cancel Job. Press OK.  
4. Scroll to the job you wish to cancel. Press OK.  
5. Answer are you sure? with Yes by pressing OK.  
6. The message display states that the job has been cancelled.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax Send Options  
Fax Send Options  
Your machine provides the following options to customize your fax jobs. You can access them at the  
machine; some of these features can also be accessed from your computer via Xerox Easy Printer  
Manager or Xerox CentreWare Internet Services. See the chart below to determine the access options  
for each feature.  
See the pages following the chart for details of these features and how to use them.  
Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
Once your job is completed, the options you have set for the current fax job will be  
returned to default status  
To access the features noted below at the computer OR to change the default settings for these  
features, follow the steps for online access at Changing Default Settings.  
Feature  
Description  
Options  
Lighten/Darken  
Adjusts the lightness or  
darkness of the output.  
Lighten +1 to +5: Lightens the image in increments to  
the lightest setting of Lighten +5; works well with dark  
print.  
Normal: Works well with standard typed or printed  
originals.  
Darken +1 to +5: Darkens the original in increments  
to the darkest setting of Darken +5; works well with  
light print.  
Access: at  
machine, at  
computer  
Resolution  
Resolution affects the  
appearance of the fax at  
the receiving fax terminal.  
A higher resolution  
produces a better quality  
image. A lower resolution  
reduces communication  
time.  
Standard: Recommended for text documents. It  
requires less communication time, but does not  
produce the best image quality for graphics and  
photos.  
Fine: Recommended for line art and photos. This is  
the default resolution and the best choice in most  
cases.  
SuperFine: Recommended for use with high quality  
photos and graphics.  
Photo Fax: Recommended for originals containing  
shades of gray or photographs.  
Color Fax: Recommended for originals with colors.  
Sending a color fax is enabled only if the remote fax  
machine supports color fax reception and you send  
the fax manually. In this mode, memory transmission  
is not available.  
Access: at  
machine, at  
computer  
Note: When your machine is set to Super Fine resolution  
and the remote fax machine does not support Super Fine  
resolution, the machine transmits using the highest  
resolution mode supported.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fax Send Options  
Feature  
Description  
Options  
Original Size  
Allows you to specify the  
size of the image to be  
scanned.  
A4  
A5  
B5 (JIS)  
Letter  
Executive  
Access: at  
machine, at  
computer  
Multi Send  
Access: at machine  
Use the Multi Send feature  
to send a fax to multiple  
locations.  
Fax 1: Use this option to enter the first fax number.  
Fax 2 - 10: You can send a fax to up to 10 addresses.  
One of them can be a group address f rom Address  
book.  
Refer to Multi Send for instructions.  
Delay Send  
Access: at machine  
Sets your machine to send Refer to Delay Send for instructions.  
a fax at a later time when  
you will not be present.  
Priority Send  
Access: at machine  
Use when a high priority  
fax needs to be sent ahead  
of reserved or current  
operations.  
Job Name: Enter a name for the job using the keypad  
(optional).  
Refer to Priority Send for instructions.  
Forward  
Sets the machine to  
Fax: Use this option to forward every fax received or  
forward all received or sent  
faxes to an additional fax  
or a PC destination.  
sent to an additional fax number not in the job list.  
PC: Use this option to forward all received or sent  
faxes to a networked PC.  
Once you enable this feature, it occurs for every fax  
job until you disable the feature.  
Access: Forward to  
PC only from  
computer, Forward  
to Fax at machine  
and from computer  
Refer to Fax Forward for instructions.  
Secure Receive  
Use to prevent your  
On: Use this option to activate Secure Receive.  
Off: Use this option to deactivate Secure Receive.  
Print: Use this option to print the faxes received into  
memory. If a 4-digit password was set when  
activating Secure Receive, this password will be  
required to print the faxes.  
received faxes from being  
accessed by unauthorized  
people. In Secure Receive  
mode, all incoming faxes  
go into memory and can  
be printed by entering a  
4-digit password.  
Access: at  
machine, at  
computer  
Note: This option only appears when there are stored jobs  
to print.  
Refer to Fax from PC for instructions.  
Add Page  
Access: at machine  
Use to add additional  
pages to a Delayed Fax job instructions.  
which is saved in memory.  
Refer to Adding Documents to a Delayed Fax for  
Cancel Job  
Access: at machine  
Use to cancel a Delayed  
Fax job which is saved in  
memory.  
Refer to Cancelling a Delayed Fax for instructions.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax Send Options  
Multi Send  
You can use the Multi Send feature to send a fax to multiple locations.  
The fax is automatically stored in memory and then transmitted from memory to the fax  
destinations entered.  
You can enter up to 10 addresses in one transmission with this feature. One of the destinations  
can be a group address of up to 200 destinations from the machine’s Address book. The total  
number of recipients can thus be 209.  
After transmission, the job is automatically erased from memory.  
You cannot send a color fax using this feature.  
Follow these steps at the machine to use the Multi Send feature:  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. At the Fax Features menu, press the up/down arrows to scroll to Multi Send and press OK.  
4. The message prompt Fax 1: _____ appears. Enter the number of the first receiving fax machine  
and press OK. You can select speed dial numbers or a group dial number using the Address book  
button. For details, see Address Book.  
Note: Once you have entered a group dial number, you cannot enter any more group dial  
numbers.  
5. The machine will prompt you for a second fax number. Enter the recipient fax number and press  
OK.  
6. After the second recipient fax is entered, the machine displays: Another fax number? Select the  
answer that fits your job, Yes or No, and press OK. To enter more fax numbers, press OK when Yes  
is highlighted and repeat the steps. You can add up to 10 addresses.  
When you have finished entering fax numbers, scroll to select No at the Another No.? prompt and  
press OK.  
7. Load originals and press Start to start the job. The machine begins scanning the originals and  
storing the data into memory.  
If using the document glass to scan more than one original, select Yes in the display prompt to  
add another page. Load another original and press OK.  
When you have finished, select No at the Another Page? prompt.  
The machine sends the fax to the numbers you entered in the order in which you entered them.  
Delay Send  
You can set your machine to send a fax at a later time when you will not be present. Use this feature to  
transmit faxes during off-peak hours or to another country or time zone.  
Once you program the machine to send a delayed fax, it will be listed in the Scheduled Jobs list. To  
see the Scheduled Jobs list, press Machine Status, at Info Pages press OK. Scroll to find Scheduled  
Jobs. Select OK, then scroll to Print. Press Ok to print the list of scheduled jobs, including delayed  
faxes.  
You cannot send a color fax using this feature.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax Send Options  
Follow these steps at the machine to program a Delayed Fax:  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. At the Fax Features menu, press the up/down arrows to scroll to Delay Send and press OK.  
4. Enter the number of the receiving fax machine and press OK.  
You can select speed dial numbers or a group dial number by pressing the Address Book button.  
For details on setting up those addresses, see Address Book.  
The display asks you to enter another fax number. To enter more fax numbers, press OK when Yes  
appears and repeat the steps. You can send to up to 10 addresses; only one can be a group  
address.  
Note: Once you have entered a group dial number, you cannot enter any more group dial  
numbers.  
When you have finished entering fax numbers, scroll to select No at the Another No.? prompt and  
press OK.  
5. Enter the Job Name you want and press OK. If you do not want to assign a name, skip this step.  
For details on how to enter alphanumeric characters, refer to Using the Keypad.  
6. Enter the time the fax should be sent using the number keypad and press OK. If you set a time  
earlier than the current time, the fax will be sent at that time on the following day.  
7. Load originals and press Start. The machine will begin storing the scanned original data into  
memory.  
Note: if you load your original at start of programming the job, the job will begin automatically  
after you enter the time and press OK.  
If using the document glass to scan more than one original, select Yes to add another page. Load  
another original and press OK.  
When you have finished, select No at the Another Page? prompt.  
The machine returns to Ready mode when the fax has been scheduled. The display reminds you that  
you are in Ready mode and that a delayed fax is scheduled.  
Adding Documents to a Delayed Fax  
At the machine, you can add additional documents to the Delayed Fax job which is saved in memory.  
1. Load the originals to be added and select the fax settings required.  
2. Press Fax on the control panel.  
3. Press Menu on the control panel.  
4. At the Fax Features menu, press the up/down arrows to scroll to Add Page and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrows until the fax job you want appears and press OK.  
6. Press Start.  
If adding more than one page, select Yes at the Another Page? prompt. Load another page and  
press OK.  
When you have finished, select No at the Another Page? prompt. The machine stores the page.  
Job programming is complete when you see the Fax prompt.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
153  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax Send Options  
Canceling a Delayed Fax  
You can cancel a Delayed Fax job which is saved in memory at the machine.  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. At the Fax Features menu, press the up/down arrows to scroll to Cancel Job and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows until the fax job you want appears and press OK.  
Press OK when Yes appears to confirm and cancel the job.  
The selected fax is deleted from memory.  
Priority Send  
This function is used when a high priority fax needs to be sent ahead of other fax jobs in memory or  
other machine operations. The fax original is scanned into memory and immediately transmitted when  
the current operation is finished.  
Follow these steps at the machine to send a priority fax job.  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to scroll to Priority Send and press OK.  
4. Enter the number of the receiving fax machine and press OK.  
You can enter a speed dial number or a group dial number or use the Address Book to find a  
number by pressing the Address Book button. For details, see Address Book.  
5. Enter the job name you want and press OK. If you do not want to assign a name, skip this step.  
For details on how to enter alphanumeric characters, refer to Using the Keypad.  
6. Load originals and press Start.  
If an original is placed on the platen glass, select Yes at the Another Page? prompt. Load another  
original and press OK.  
When you have finished, select No at the Another Page? prompt. The machine scans and sends  
the fax to the destination entered.  
Other Fax Send Options  
These features can be changed in CentreWare Internet Services.  
Feature  
Description  
Redial Term  
Redial Times  
From the Redial Term drop-down menu select the  
minutes for the term of each redial.  
From the Redial Times drop-down menu select the  
amount of times you want the machine to re-dial.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax Send Options  
Feature  
Description  
Prefix Dial  
ECM Mode  
If your telephone system requires you to enter a  
prefix in front of fax numbers, check the Prefix Dial  
box and enter prefix dial details in the Prefix Dial  
field.  
Check the ECM Mode checkbox to enable Error  
Correction Mode.  
Fax Confirmation  
Prints a confirmation page after each fax  
sent/received.  
From the Fax Confirmation drop-down menu select  
one of the send report options.  
•Off  
•On - prints a report when a fax has been sent.  
•On-Error - prints a report when an error occurs.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax Receive Options  
Fax Receive Options  
This section covers the following:  
Fax Receive Modes  
Changing the Receive Mode  
Secure Receive Option  
Other Fax Receive Settings  
Fax Receive Modes  
You have several choices for how you want to receive faxes with this machine:  
Fax: Where the machine answers an incoming fax call and immediately goes into fax reception  
mode, according to the features you have set up on the machine.  
Tel: Receives a fax when you press [on hook dial button] and then Start, where you are at the  
machine.  
Answering machine: Where you have an answering machine connected to the machine which is  
set up to answer faxes as they come in.  
These options are accessible at the machine through the Fax Setup process, as described below.  
Another option, Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection or DRPD, requires a special telephone company  
service on your phone line and is accessible in the System Setup menu on your machine (see procedure  
below). With DRPD, you program your fax machine to recognize particular rings as fax machines  
sending faxes. See Distinctive Ring Mode for instructions on how to set up and use this fax receive  
option.  
Changing the Receive Mode  
The Receive mode was set up at installation of your machine. To change the mode:  
1. Press the Info button on the control panel. Scroll to Fax Setup and press OK.  
2. Scroll to Receiving. Press OK.  
3. Scroll to Receive mode. Press OK.  
4. Select the mode you want to use by scrolling through the list. Press OK.  
Note: To set up a DRPD receive mode requires different steps, as described below.  
The modes are described below.  
Fax Mode  
Faxes will be received as they come in and either printed immediately, forwarded, and/or saved,  
depending on the features you have setup as defaults on your machine.  
Since your machine is a multi-tasking device, it can receive faxes while you are making copies or  
printing. If you receive a fax while you are copying or printing, your machine stores the incoming fax in  
its memory. Then, as soon as you finish copying or printing, the machine automatically prints the fax.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
156  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Fax Receive Options  
Tel Mode  
In this mode, you must be at the machine. You can receive a fax call by pressing the On Hook Dial  
button to open the fax line; you will hear a dial tone. Press Start when you hear a fax tone from the  
remote machine. The machine begins receiving a fax. If a handset is available you can answer calls  
using the handset.  
Ans/Fax Mode  
To use this mode, you must attach an answering machine to the EXT socket on the back of your  
machine. If your machine detects a fax tone on the line, it automatically starts to receive the fax. If  
your answering machine detects a person leaving a message, it saves the message.  
Notes:  
If you have set your machine to this mode and your answering machine is switched off,  
or no answering machine is connected to EXT socket, your machine automatically goes  
into Fax mode after a predefined number of rings.  
If your answering machine has a user-selectable ring counter, set the machine to answer  
incoming calls within 1 ring.  
If you are in Tel mode when the answering machine is connected to your machine, you  
must switch off the answering machine. otherwise, the outgoing message from the  
answering machine will interrupt your phone conversation.  
Distinctive Ring Mode  
Distinctive Ring is a telephone company service which enables a user to use a single telephone line to  
answer several different telephone numbers. The particular number someone uses to call you is  
identified by different ringing patterns, which consist of various combinations of long and short ringing  
sounds. This feature is often used by answering services who answer telephones for many different  
clients and need to know which number someone is calling in on to properly answer the phone.  
Using the Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) feature, your fax machine can learn the ring  
pattern you designate to be answered by the fax machine. Unless you change it, this ringing pattern  
will continue to be recognized and answered as a fax call, and all other ringing patterns will be  
forwarded to the extension telephone or answering machine plugged into the EXT socket. You can  
easily suspend or change DRPD at any time by disabling the DRPD fax receive mode.  
Before using the DRPD option, Distinctive Ring service must be installed on your telephone line by the  
telephone company. To set up DRPD, you will need another telephone line at your location, or someone  
available to dial your fax number from outside.  
For information about setting up DRPD, refer to Setting Up DRPD.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
157  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Fax Receive Options  
Using Secure Receive  
You may need to prevent your received faxes from being accessed by unauthorized people. In secure  
receive mode, all incoming faxes go into memory until they are accessed and released for printing. A  
4-digit pincode can be set to prevent faxes being printed by unauthorized users. If Secure Receive  
mode is deactivated, any faxes stored in memory are automatically printed.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
Activating Secure Receive  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to Secure Receive and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to On and press OK.  
5. Enter the four-digit pincode you want to use and press OK.  
You can activate secure receive mode without setting a pincode, but this will not protect your  
faxes.  
6. Re-enter the pincode to confirm it and press OK.  
When a fax is received in secure receive mode, your machine stores it in memory and shows Secure  
Receive to let you know that a fax has been received in that mode.  
Printing Secure Faxes  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to Secure Receive and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to Print and press OK.  
5. If required, enter the four-digit pincode and press OK.  
The machine prints all of the faxes stored in memory.  
Deactivating Secure Receive Mode  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to highlight Secure Receive and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to highlight Off and press OK.  
5. If required, enter the four-digit pincode and press OK.  
The mode is deactivated and the machine prints all faxes stored in memory.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
158  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fax Receive Options  
Other Fax Receive Settings  
These options can be accessed at the machine or at the computer.  
Feature  
Description  
Receive Mode  
Tel - receives a fax when user manually accepts via  
On Hook button or handset.  
• Fax - answers an incoming fax call and immediately  
goes into the fax reception mode.  
• Ans/Fax - select when an answering machine is  
attached to the machine.  
Ring to Answer  
Determines the number of times the calling fax  
machine should ring before your machine answers.  
Stamp Receive Name  
Check the Stamp Receive Name checkbox to enable  
the machine to print a page number and the date  
and time of receipt on the bottom of each page of a  
received fax.  
Receive Start Code  
Initiates fax reception from an extension phone  
plugged into the socket on the back of the machine.  
Select the required start code from the menu (the  
default is 9).  
Auto Reduction  
Discard Size  
Select to automatically reduce large documents  
received to fit on the fax paper size of your machine.  
Select to automatically reduce large documents  
received to fit on the fax paper size of your machine.  
Two-sided fax printing  
Select to enable printing of two-sided faxes at your  
machine.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fax Forward Sent/Received  
Fax Forward Sent/Received  
You can set the machine to forward all received and/or sent faxes to another fax or to a networked PC.  
This feature may be useful if you are out of the office but have to receive faxes, for example, or if you  
want to archive a copy of transmissions.  
When you forward a fax to a PC, you must use CentreWare Internet Services to set up the destination  
details. You can forward a fax to one destination. Refer to CentreWare Internet Services for instructions.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
Forwarding Sent Faxes  
You can set the machine to forward a copy of every fax sent. The forward destination can be another  
fax number. When this feature is enabled, a copy of all sent faxes will be forwarded to the destination  
set until the option is deactivated. To deactivate Fax Forward, see the steps below.  
To Enable Fax Forward Send from machine:  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to scroll to Send Forward and press OK.  
4. Select the option required:  
Fax  
a. Scroll to Forward to Fax and press OK.  
b. Scroll to On and press OK.  
c. Enter the fax number to which faxes are to be sent and press OK.  
To Enable Fax Forward Send from CentreWare Internet Services:  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator ID (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login. Click  
Properties.  
5. In the Machine Settings link select the Fax link on left navigation.  
6. Select the Send Forward link on left navigation.  
7. Click Enable in the Fax Forward to Fax area.  
8. Enter a Forward No. and select Apply.  
9. All faxes sent from your machine will also send (forward) a copy of the fax to the number you  
entered here.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
160  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax Forward Sent/Received  
Forwarding Received Faxes  
You can forward all faxes received by your machine to another fax number or a networked PC. If this  
feature is enabled, when the machine receives a fax, it is stored in memory and then sent immediately  
to the destination you have set. All received faxes will continue to be forwarded to the destination until  
the option is deactivated. To deactivate Fax Forward, refer to Deactivating Fax Forward below.  
To Enable Fax Forward Receive from the machine:  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to scroll to Rcv. Forward and press OK.  
4. Select the option required: Forward to Fax, Forward to PC, Forward and Print  
a. Forward to Fax: Scroll to On and press OK. Enter the fax number to which faxes are to be sent  
and press OK.  
b. Forward to PC: Scroll to On and press OK.  
c. Forward and Print: Scroll to On and press OK.  
Note: Forward and Print will cause the device to print the fax locally as well as forward, using  
whatever forwarding method had been enabled.  
To Enable Fax Forward Receive from CentreWare Internet Services:  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar. Press Enter.  
2. Select Properties.  
3. If prompted, enter the Administrator ID (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
4. Click Properties.  
5. In the Machine Settings link select the Fax link.  
6. Select the Receive Forward link.  
7. Click Enable in the Fax Forward to Fax area.  
8. Enter the fax number to which you want the fax to be forwarded: Forward No.  
9. Enter a Start Time and End Time; these include both date and time.  
10. If you want to forward the fax copy to a PC, click that Enable box.  
11. If you want to have the forwarded fax printed on receipt, click Enable for that option.  
12. Select Apply.  
To Enable Fax Forward Receive to PC:  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar. Press Enter.  
2. Select Properties.  
3. If prompted, enter the Administrator ID (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
4. Click Properties.  
5. In the Machine Settings link select the Fax link.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
161  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fax Forward Sent/Received  
6. Select the Send Forward link.  
7. Click Enable in the Fax Forward to PC area.  
8. Enter the PC address to which you want the fax to be forwarded.  
9. Enter a Start Time and End Time; these include both date and time.  
10. Select Apply.  
Deactivating Fax Forward  
Follow the steps below to deactivate the Fax Forward option.  
From the machine:  
1. Press Fax on the control panel.  
2. Press Menu on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to scroll to Fax Feature and press OK.  
4. Scroll to Forward and press OK.  
5. Scroll to Fax, and press OK.  
6. Scroll to Send Forward or Receive Forward and press OK.  
7. Scroll to Off and press OK.  
To Disable Fax Forward from CentreWare Internet Services:  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator ID (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
5. On the CentreWare Internet Services page, click Properties.  
6. In the Machine Settings link, select the Fax link.  
7. Select the Send Forward or Receive Forward link, whichever one you want to disable.  
8. Click the check box in the appropriate feature’s Enable box to remove check and disable feature.  
9. Select Apply. The Fax Forward feature will no longer be active at your machine.  
Note: When you disable Receive Forward, your machine will return to the default Receive mode  
you have set up--Fax, Tel, Ans/Fax or DRPD.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
162  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fax from PC  
Fax from PC  
You can send a fax from your PC without going to the machine with your hard copy original. With this  
convenient feature, you send your file to the fax machine as you do a print job, and then the machine  
sends out your file as it does a fax job.  
To send a fax from your PC you will need to install the PC-Fax software and customize the software  
settings. Refer to Installation and Setup for these setup instructions.  
To send a fax from the PC:  
1. Open the document you want to send.  
2. Select Print from the File menu.  
The Print window is displayed. It may look slightly different depending on your application.  
3. Select Xerox MFP PC Fax from your printer list in the Name drop-down list box.  
4. Select Printer Properties.  
5. Select OK. The Fax Properties screen displays.  
Two choices are offered:  
Specify fax options before sending: Use to set image quality parameters, add a cover page and  
message before sending the fax.  
Select this option, select the Address Book you wish to use (from your PC), click OK, and Print  
window reappears. Click OK.  
The Fax Options page appears.  
Check that the correct printer is identified at top. If not, select Change at right and select the  
printer you want.  
Select a Recipient from the pull-down menu, or type in a recipient address, or click the  
Address Book button to search for an address. You can specify up to 15 recipients.  
Choose the Quality option: Standard or Fine. Choose the Original Type: Text, Text/Photo, or  
Photo.  
To add a Cover page and message, select the check box. Fill in the text fields for the Cover  
page.  
Automatically send to: Use to send the fax without creating a cover or making further option  
selections.  
Select this button.  
Select the Add button to add new recipients, either by directly typing names and fax numbers  
or by adding names from the relevant address book (from your PC). You can select up 15  
addresses.  
If you want to know that the fax has been delivered to the destination fax, click Notify me on  
delivery. For a preview of your document, including the cover page, click Preview.  
Click OK to send the document from your PC to your fax machine, which will fax the  
document to the destination fax or faxes listed.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
163  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax from PC  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E-mail  
8
The WorkCentre 3215/3225 E-mail feature creates a digital file from your hard copy original, and sends  
it to the e-mail address you have designated. You can scan the originals and send the scanned images  
to several destinations from the machine by e-mail.  
This chapter includes:  
E-mail Procedure  
E-mail Options  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
E-mail Procedure  
E-mail Procedure  
If E-mail has been enabled, an electronic file can be created from a hard copy original. The electronic  
file can be e-mailed to a specified address.  
Note: Refer to Installation and Setup for instructions on enabling E-mail.  
This section describes the basic procedure for e-mailing. Follow the steps below.  
Loading documents  
Enter the e-mail address  
Select the features  
Start the job  
Stop the e-mail job (if necessary)  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
If an authentication feature is enabled, you may need an account before using the machine. To get an  
account, or for more information, contact the System Administrator.  
Loading Documents  
Documents can be loaded either into the automatic document feeder or onto the platen glass.  
Automatic Document Feeder  
The automatic document feeder can hold a maximum of 40 originals of 20 lb (80 g/m²) thickness.  
1. Load documents to be scanned face up in the input tray of the automatic document feeder with  
the top of the document to the left of the tray.  
2. Move the document guide to just touch both sides of the document.  
Platen Glass  
The platen glass can be used for oversized, torn, or damaged originals and for books and magazines.  
1. Open the automatic document feeder and place single  
documents face down on the platen glass aligned with the  
rear left corner.  
2. The default document size is 8.5 x 11” or A4. For other sized  
documents, change the Original Size option. Refer to E-mail  
Options for further information.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
166  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
E-mail Procedure  
Enter the E-mail Address  
1. Press the E-mail button on the control panel.  
If Authentication is enabled, enter your Login ID and Password (if required).  
2. When Enter From Address: appears, enter the sender’s e-mail address and  
press OK.  
Note: The administrator can set up the e-mail function in CWIS so that the user  
at the machine sees choices for the ‘from’ address.  
Note: Use orange C button to erase keyboard entry.  
3. Enter To address. Press OK.  
4. When Another address? prompt appears, choose appropriate response and press OK.  
5. When File Format appears, scroll to select the file format you wish to send the document in via  
e-mail.  
If Send to Myself? appears, press the left/right arrows to select Yes or No and press OK.  
6. When Enter Destination Addresses: appears, enter the recipient’s e-mail address and press OK.  
Use the .com button to add commonly used address text to the e-mail  
address, for example .com or @yourdomainname.com. Press the .com key  
repeatedly until the text required is displayed and press OK. The text is  
added to the address. The Smart Key text can be customized using  
CentreWare Internet Services, refer to Address Book for instructions.  
E-mail addresses can also be added using the Address Book. (See Address  
Book for instructions.)  
Press the down arrow and enter additional e-mail addresses if required and  
press OK.  
7. If File Format appears, select the file format required and press start.  
Select the Features  
Various features can be selected for your e-mail job. The most common features are selected from the  
control panel. Once you have made a selection, press Back to return to the Ready screen.  
1. The following features are available through the Menu button:  
Note: Some of the following options may be unavailable depending on your machine  
configuration.  
Original Size  
Original Type  
Use to set the size of the image being scanned.  
Used to improve the image quality by selecting the document type for  
the originals.  
Resolution  
Sets the image resolution. A higher resolution increases the file size.  
Sets the color mode of the scanned image.  
Output Color  
Lighten/Darken  
Provides manual control to adjust the lightness or darkness of the  
scanned images.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
E-mail Procedure  
2. Press the up/down arrows until the feature you want displays and press OK. Select the setting  
required and press OK.  
For information about each of the options refer to E-mail Options on page 169.  
Start the E-mail Job  
1. Press the Start button.  
The images are scanned and sent to the e-mail address or addresses entered.  
Stop the E-mail Job  
Follow the steps below to cancel an active e-mail job.  
1. Press the Stop button on the control panel.  
Follow the steps below to cancel a queued e-mail job.  
1. Press the Job Status button on the control panel to display the active jobs.  
2. Scroll to select the job required, and press OK.  
3. Select Delete and OK.  
4. Select Yes to delete the job or No to return to previous screen.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
168  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
E-mail Options  
E-mail Options  
Your machine provides the following options to customize your E-mail jobs. Use the Menu button to  
access the options. For information about changing the default E-mail settings, refer to Installation  
and Setup.  
Note: Some options may be unavailable depending on your machine configuration.  
Feature  
Description  
Options  
Original Size  
Allows you to specify the  
size of the image to be  
scanned.  
A4  
A5  
B5  
Letter  
Legal  
Original Type  
Resolution  
Used to improve the  
image quality by selecting  
the document type for the  
originals.  
Text: Use for originals containing mostly text.  
Text and Photo: Use for originals with mixed text and  
photographs.  
Photo: Use when the originals are photographs.  
Affects the appearance of  
the scanned image. A  
higher resolution produces  
a better quality image. A  
lower resolution reduces  
communication time when  
sending the file over the  
network.  
600 dpi: higher quality for text and line art, and  
recommended for photos and graphics.  
300 dpi: Recommended for high quality text  
documents that are to pass through OCR applications.  
Also recommended for high quality line art or medium  
quality photos and graphics.  
200 dpi: Recommended for average quality text  
documents and line art. Does not produce the best  
image quality for photos and graphics.  
100 dpi: Recommended for lower quality text  
documents or if a smaller file size is required.  
Output Color  
Select to produce black  
and white, grayscale or  
color output.  
Color: Use to select color output from your original.  
Grayscale: Use if output is to be in shades of gray.  
Black and White: Use to select black and white  
output regardless of the color of your original.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
E-mail Options  
Feature  
Description  
Options  
File Format  
Determines the type of file  
created and can be  
temporarily changed for  
the current job. Select the  
file format you wish to use  
for your scanned image.  
Single-TIFF (Tagged Image File Format): Produces a  
graphic file that can be opened by a variety of graphic  
software packages across a variety of computer  
platforms. A separate file is produced for each image  
scanned.  
Multi-TIFF: Produces a single TIFF file containing  
several pages of scanned images. A more specialized  
software is required to open this type of file format.  
PDF (Portable Document Format): Allows recipients  
with the right software to view, print or edit the  
electronic file, no matter what their computer  
platform.  
JPEG (Joint Photographic Experts Group): Produces  
a compressed graphic file that can be opened by a  
variety of graphic software packages across a variety  
of computer platforms. A separate file is produced for  
each image scanned.  
Lighten/Darken  
Adjusts the lightness or  
darkness of the output.  
Lighten +1 to +5: Lightens the image in increments to  
the lightest setting of Lighten +5; works well with dark  
print.  
Normal: Works well with standard typed or printed  
originals.  
Darken +1 to +5: Darkens the original in increments  
to the darkest setting of Darken +5; works well with  
light print.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Address Book  
9
This chapter includes:  
Address Book Overview  
Using Address Book From the Control Panel  
Using Address Book In CWIS  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Address Book Overview  
Address Book Overview  
With the convenient Address Book feature on the Xerox WorkCentre 3215/3225 you can have all the  
addresses you need at your fingertips for fax and e-mail jobs. Once the Address Book has been enabled  
during installation and setup, you can enter individual addresses, group addresses, and speed dial  
addresses and store them in your Address Book at the machine for repeated use during fax and e-mail  
jobs.  
You can also search a global network address book from your machine if the LDAP function has been  
set up. See Installation and Setup for directions on how to set up and enable the Address Book for your  
machine.  
Use the Address Book when you are sending a fax from the Xerox WorkCentre  
3215/3225 to another fax machine, a PC, or an e-mail address. You can access and  
perform address functions in Address Book from either the machine’s control panel or  
from your computer using CentreWare Internet Services (CWIS).  
Key Address Book functions include:  
The Address Book can store up to 500 entries on the WorkCentre 3215/3225.  
Those include up to 200 Speed Dial numbers.  
You can search your local addresses or your network’s global address book (if  
LDAP is set up).  
You can print out a list of all the address book entries from the Machine Status/Info Pages menu.  
You can use Address Book at the machine or from CentreWare Internet Services (CWIS).  
You can add addresses at any time from either the machine or CWIS.  
172  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using Address Book From the Control Panel  
Using Address Book From the Control Panel  
From the Address Book button on the control panel you can:  
Search for addresses  
Add, delete, or edit addresses for Individuals, Fax Groups, or E-mail Groups  
Establish Speed Dial and Group Dial numbers for addresses  
Enter and use Smart Key addresses  
Print the Address Book.  
To use the Address Book in a fax or e-mail job from the machine’s control panel, you  
must be in the appropriate function mode for the job. Select the fax or e-mail button before accessing  
the Address Book to find the addresses you need to perform the job.  
Searching the Address Book  
There are two ways to search for an address in the Address Book memory. You can either preview the  
entries sequentially or search by entering the first letters of the name associated with the address.  
1. Press Fax or E-mail on the control panel depending on the type of job you want to do.  
2. For E-mail, the From Address:_________ prompt appears. Press OK. The Enter To Address: ______  
field appears.  
For Fax, the To: ________ prompt appears in the user interface.  
3. Press the Address Book button on the control panel.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select either Local or LDAP/Global. Press OK.  
5. Enter a few letters of the name you are searching for. The machine will return matching names.  
6. Press the up/down arrows until the name and address you want displays and press OK.  
Speed Dial Numbers  
You can store up to 200 frequently-used fax or email addresses as speed dial numbers.  
Registering a Speed Dial Number  
1. Press Fax or E-mail on the control panel.  
2. Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select New & Edit and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Speed Dial and press OK.  
5. Enter a speed dial number between 1 and 200 and press OK.  
If an entry is already stored in the number you choose, a message is displayed. To start over with  
another speed dial number, press Back. Enter another, unassigned speed dial number.  
6. Enter the name you want assigned to that speed dial number and press OK.  
For details on how to enter alphanumeric characters, refer to Using the Keypad in Getting Started.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using Address Book From the Control Panel  
7. Enter the fax or e-mail address you want to assign to that speed dial number and press OK.  
8. Press Stop to return to Ready mode.  
Editing Speed Dial Numbers  
1. Press Fax or E-mail on the control panel.  
2. Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select New & Edit and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Speed Dial and press OK.  
5. Enter the speed dial number you want to edit and press OK.  
6. Edit the details required:  
Change the name and press OK.  
Change the number/address and press OK.  
7. Press Stop to return to Ready mode.  
Using Speed Dial Numbers  
When you are prompted to enter a destination number while sending a fax or e-mail, enter the speed  
dial number representing the stored number you want.  
For a one-digit (0-9) speed dial number, press and hold the corresponding digit button on the  
number keypad.  
For a two or three-digit speed dial number, press the first digit button(s) and then hold down the  
last digit button.  
Group Dial Numbers  
If you frequently send your documents to several destinations, you can group these destinations and  
set them under a group dial number. You can then use a group dial number to send a document to all  
of the destinations within the group. You can set up to 200 group dial numbers using the destination’s  
existing speed dial numbers.  
Registering a Group Dial Number  
1. Press Fax or E-mail on the control panel.  
2. Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select New & Edit and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Group Dial and press OK.  
5. Enter a group dial number between 1 and 200 and press OK.  
If an entry is already stored in the number you choose, the display shows a message to allow you  
to change it.  
6. Enter the name you want and press OK.  
For details on how to enter alphanumeric characters, refer to Using the Keypad in Getting Started.  
7. Enter the first few letters of the speed dial’s name you want.  
174  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using Address Book From the Control Panel  
8. Press the up/down arrows until the name and number you want displays and press OK.  
9. Press OK when Yes appears at the Add Another? prompt.  
Repeat the steps to add other speed dial numbers into the group.  
When you have finished, press the left/right arrows to select No at the Add Another? prompt and  
press OK.  
10. Press Stop to return to Ready mode.  
Editing a Group Dial Number  
1. Press Fax or E-mail on the control panel.  
2. Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select New & Edit and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Group Dial and press OK.  
5. Enter the group dial number you want to edit and press OK.  
6. Enter the first few letters of the speed dial name in that group you want to add or delete.  
7. Scroll until the name and number you want displays and press OK.  
If you entered a new speed dial number, Add? appears.  
If you enter a speed dial number stored in the group, Delete? appears.  
Press OK to add or delete the number.  
8. Press OK when Yes appears to add or delete more numbers and repeat the steps.  
When you have finished, press the left/right arrows to select No at the Another Number? and  
press OK.  
9. Press Stop to return to Ready mode.  
Using Group Dial Numbers  
To use a group dial entry, you need to search for and select it from memory.  
When you are prompted to enter a destination number while sending a fax or e-mail, press Address  
Book.  
There are two ways to search for a number in memory. You can either search from A to Z sequentially,  
or you can search by entering the first letters of the name associated with the number.  
Searching Sequentially  
1. Press Fax or E-mail on the control panel.  
2. Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Search & Dial and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Group Dial and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select All and press OK.  
6. Scroll until the name and number you want displays. You can search upwards or downwards  
through the entire memory in alphabetical order.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Address Book From the Control Panel  
Searching using the Name  
1. Press Fax or E-mail on the control panel.  
2. Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Search & Dial and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Group Dial and press OK.  
5. Press the up/down arrows to select Search ID and press OK.  
Enter the first few letters of the name you want.  
6. Scroll until the group dial’s name and number you want displays.  
Deleting an Address Book Entry  
1. Press Fax or E-mail on the control panel.  
2. Press Address Book on the control panel.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Delete and press OK.  
4. Press the up/down arrows to select Speed Dial or Group Dial and press OK.  
5. Scroll until the searching method you want displays and press OK.  
Select Search All to search for an entry by scanning through all entries in Address Book.  
Select Search ID to search for an entry by entering the first few letters of the name.  
6. Scroll until the name you want displays and press OK.  
Or, enter the first letters. Scroll until the name you want displays and press OK.  
7. Press OK when Yes appears to confirm the deletion.  
8. Press Stop to return to Ready mode.  
Smart Key Addresses  
The Smart Key addresses enable you to quickly access and select commonly used e-mail address text  
from the .com button on the control panel. For example .com or @yourdomainname.com. Up to six  
Smart Key addresses can be set up using CentreWare Internet Services.  
The Smart Key addresses are selected by pressing the .com key on the control panel.  
When entering the e-mail address, press the .com key repeatedly until the address text  
required is displayed and press OK.  
Printing the Local Address Book  
1. Press the Machine Status button on the control panel.  
2. Select Information Pages and press OK.  
3. Press the up/down arrows to select Address Book and press OK at the print prompt. Your local  
Address Book listings will print from your machine.  
176  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using Address Book in CWIS  
Using Address Book in CWIS  
You can use the address book from your PC through CWIS. Access numbers and initiate fax and e-mail  
jobs from your PC using addresses stored in your Xerox 3215/3225 Address Book.  
From Address Book in CWIS you can:  
Search for addresses  
Add, delete, or edit addresses for Individuals, Fax Groups, or E-mail Groups  
Establish Speed Dial and Group Dial numbers for addresses.  
Search for An Address  
To search for an address in CWIS:  
1. Access CWIS via Easy Printer Manager or by entering your machine’s IP address in your browser  
window and pressing Enter.  
2. From the CWIS home page, click Address Book.  
3. Select the type of address you are seeking: Individual, Fax Group or E-mail Group.  
4. Select the address from the list on screen. You can scroll through the Address Book or search by  
user name in the search window at the top of the list.  
To Add an Address:  
1. Select the type of address you want to add in the left column: Individual, Fax Group or E-mail  
Group.  
2. When the list displays on screen, click Add.  
3. Enter the information in the form to add a new person to the Address Book, or click on a listing in  
the display to add an existing address to a Group.  
4. Assign the new address a Speed Dial number if you wish.  
5. Click Apply. The address will appear in the desired list.  
To Edit or Delete an Address  
1. Select the type of address you want to change or delete in the left column: Individual, Fax Group  
or E-mail Group.  
2. When the list displays on screen, click on the address you wish to change or delete.  
3. Select Edit or Delete, whichever action you want to take with the address.  
4. When finished making the change, click Apply. The address listing will be changed.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using Address Book in CWIS  
178  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Security  
10  
This chapter describes how to configure the Security features for the machine.  
The following topics are mentioned in this chapter:  
Security at Xerox  
Security Settings  
Machine Digital Certificate Management  
SNMP  
SNMPv3  
IP Sec  
IP Filtering  
802.1X Authentication  
Authentication  
Xerox WorkCentre 3215/3225  
User Guide  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security at Xerox  
Security at Xerox  
For the latest information on securely installing, setting up and operating your machine see the Xerox  
Security Information Web site located at www.xerox.com/security.  
Security Settings  
To prevent unauthorized changes to printer settings, ensure a login ID and password is entered in the  
System Administrator area.  
Administrator Accounts  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the System Security link.  
6. Select System Administrator.  
7. If required, enter Administrator details for:  
Name  
Phone Number  
Location  
E-mail Address  
8. The WebUI Access Control check box controls access to the Internet Services screen.  
9. To change the Administrator Password, select the Change Password check box and enter the  
required Login ID and password. The defaults are admin and 1111 respectively.  
10. Select the Advanced button for Advanced Access Control.  
11. Select Protect Login IPv4 Address if required, and enter the required login IP address that you  
want to protect in the IPv4 Address box.  
12. Select the required option for Login Failure Policy. The options are: Off, 3 times, and 5 times.  
13. Select the required number of minutes from the Auto Logout menu.  
14. Select Security Settings Reset to enable this option if required.  
15. Select Save.  
16. To control access to the machine control panel, select the Enable check box to enable LUI Access  
Control.  
17. Select Apply to save the changes.  
18. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
180  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Security Settings  
Feature Management  
The Feature Management screen allows you to control the Services, Physical Ports, PC Scan Security,  
and Network Protocols that are available on the machine.  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Click Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side select the System Security link.  
6. Select the Feature Management link in the directory tree.  
7. To enable or disable a feature, select the required Enable check box or Disable link.  
For the LPR/LPD Protocol, enter the required port number. (The default is 515).  
For Raw TCP/IP Printing Protocol, enter the required port number (The default is 9100).  
8. Click Apply to save the changes.  
9. Select OK.  
Restart Device  
The Restart Device screen allows you to reboot the machine remotely from your desktop.  
Note: When the machine is restarted, the Network Controller will take some time to restart.  
The network connectivity will be unavailable during this time.  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Click Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the System Security link.  
6. Select the Restart Device link in the directory tree.  
7. To reboot the machine, select the required Restart Now button.  
8. The Do you really want to restart the device screen appears. Click Yes. The machine will reboot.  
CentreWare Internet Services may be unavailable for several minutes while the machine reboots.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
181  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Machine Digital Certificate Management  
Machine Digital Certificate Management  
The following topics are covered in this section:  
Overview  
Information Checklist  
Access the Machine Digital Certificate Management Screen  
Create a Self-Signed Certificate  
Install a CA Signed Device Certificate  
Enable Secure Connection  
Overview  
The machine can be configured for secure access with the SSL (Secure Socket Layer) protocol via  
Digital Certificates. SSL enables secure access to the machine.  
To enable SSL on a machine, it needs to have its own digital certificate. When clients make a request to  
the machine, it exports the certificate to provide an encrypted channel.  
There are two options available to obtain a server certificate for the machine:  
Have the machine create a Self-Signed Certificate  
Create a request to have a Certificate Authority sign a certificate that can be uploaded to the  
machine.  
A self-signed certificate means that the machine signs its own certificate as trusted and creates the  
public key for the certificate to be used in SSL encryption.  
A certificate from a Certificate Authority or a server functioning as a Certificate Authority (for example  
Windows 2000 running Certificate Services) can be uploaded to the machine.  
Note: A separate request is required for each Xerox machine.  
Information Checklist  
Ensure that the machine is configured with the following items:  
An IP Address or Host Name must be configured on the machine.  
DNS must be enabled and configured on the machine.  
Note: This is used to set the start time for self-signed certificates.  
Access the Machine Digital Certificate Management Screen  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select the Properties icon.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
182  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Machine Digital Certificate Management  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Click Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Network Security link.  
6. Select the Digital Certificate link. The Certificate Management page displays.  
7. Select Add.  
Select one of the following options:  
Install/Create Device Certificate or CSR. The following options are available:  
Create a Self-signed Device Certificate  
Install CA signed Device Certificate  
Create Certificate Signing Request (CSR)  
Install Root Certificate  
Create a Self-Signed Certificate  
1. In the Install/Create New Certificate area, select Create a Self-Signed Device Certificate.  
2. Select Next.  
3. In the Self-signed Certificate area:  
a. Enter a Friendly Name.  
b. In the 2 Letter Country Code field, enter the Country Code that represents the country in  
which the machine is located. The country code must be entered as a two-character ISO 3166  
country code.  
c. If required, enter details in the following fields:  
State/Province Name  
Locality Name  
Organization Name  
Organization Unit  
Information entered for these options should describe the machine as per the X500 directory  
scheme but can be any value which is meaningful to the customer to identify the machine.  
Note: The Common Name is taken from the machine’s IP Address/Host Name and Domain Name.  
d. In the Valid Period box, enter the number of days that the certificate should be valid. Once  
the specified time is reached, the certificate will expire. The start time is based on the current  
machine system time so it is important that the time is set correctly on the machine.  
e. Enter the E-mail Address of the Administrator who is responsible for the secure management  
of the machine.  
4. Select the Next button. A message displays to show the success of the certificate creation.  
5. Click the Close button. The certificate displays in the Certificate Management area.  
6. Follow the steps in Enable Secure Connection.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
183  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Machine Digital Certificate Management  
Create a Certificate Signing Request  
1. In the Install/Create New Certificate area select Create Certificate Signing Request.  
2. Select Next.  
3. In the Certificate Signing Request (CSR) area:  
a. Enter a Friendly Name to identify the request.  
b. In the 2 Letter Country Code field enter the Country Code that represents the country in  
which the machine is located. The country code must be entered as a two-character ISO 3166  
country code.  
c. If required, enter details in the following fields:  
State/Province Name  
Locality Name  
Organization Name  
Organization Unit  
Information entered for these options should describe the machine as per the X500 directory  
scheme but can be any value which is meaningful to the customer to identify the machine.  
Note: The Common Name is taken from the machine’s IP Address/Host Name and Domain Name.  
d. Enter the E-mail Address of the Administrator who is responsible for the secure management  
of the machine.  
4. Click Next.  
5. In the Certificate Signing Request (CSR) area, click Download.  
6. Send the downloaded file to your Certificate Authority for digital signing.  
7. When you receive the signed certificate back from the Certificate Authority, follow the steps below  
to Install a CA Signed Device Certificate.  
Install a CA Signed Device Certificate  
1. In the Install/Create New Certificate area, select Install CA Signed Device Certificate.  
2. Select Next.  
3. In the Certificate Information area:  
a. Enter a Friendly Name to identify the certificate  
b. Enter the required Private Password and Confirm Password.  
c. In the CA Signed Certificate area, click Browse to find the certificate file on your computer.  
Select the file.  
d. Click Next.  
4. Select the Apply button to accept the changes.  
If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select OK.  
5. If successful, the Current Status area displays a confirmation message.  
6. Follow the steps in Enable Secure Connection.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
184  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Machine Digital Certificate Management  
Install Root Certificate  
1. In the Install Root Certificate area, select Install New Root Certificate.  
2. Select Next.  
3. In the Self Signed Certificate area:  
a. Enter a Friendly Name to identify the certificate.  
b. In the Root Certificate area click Browse to find the certificate file on your computer. Select  
the file.  
c. Click Next.  
4. Select the Apply button to accept the changes.  
If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
5. If successful, the Current Status area displays a confirmation message.  
6. Follow the steps in Enable Secure Connection.  
Enable Secure Connection  
Once the machine has a machine Server Certificate, you can enable Secure Connection.  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select the Properties icon.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Click Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Network Security link.  
6. Select the Secure Connection link.  
7. Click the Select Certificate button and select the required certificate. Click Select. The certificate  
displays in the Certificate for Secure Connection area.  
8. In the Secure HTTP area, select the required option in the HTTPs menu. Select Both HTTP and  
HTTPs to enable Secure IPP, or select HTTPs Only.  
9. Select Import and Export Functions if required.  
10. If you selected Both HTTP and HTTPs, select On from the IPPs menu if required.  
11. Select Apply to save the changes.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
185  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Machine Digital Certificate Management  
Edit or Delete a Certificate  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select the Properties icon.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Click Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Network Security link.  
6. Select the Digital Certificate link. The Certificate Management page displays with a list of the  
certificates installed on this machine.  
7. Select the box next to the Friendly Name of the certificate that you want to edit or delete.  
Select the Edit button to edit the certificate. Make the required changes and click Apply.  
Select the Delete button to delete the certificate, and click Yes to confirm.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP  
SNMP  
SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) settings can be configured via CentreWare Internet  
Services.  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select the Properties icon.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Click Properties.  
5. In the Network Settings link, select the SNMP link.  
6. Select SNMPv1/v2.  
a. Select the Enable check box to enable SNMPv1/v2 Protocol.  
b. Select the required Community Name from the list, or click Add to add a new SNMP  
Community. The Add pop up menu appears.  
Enter the required Name for the SNMP Community.  
Select the required Access Permission.  
7. Select Apply to save the changes.  
8. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
SNMP Traps  
You can specify IPv4 Trap Destination Addresses.  
1. From the SNMP page, in the SNMP Traps area select Add.  
2. In the Trap Destination Address area, enter details in the IPv4 Address and Port Number fields.  
3. In the Traps area, enter the name in the TRAP Community Name field.  
4. For Traps to be received select the check boxes to select the following Traps:  
Printer Traps  
Cold Start Traps  
Warm Start Traps  
5. Select Apply to save the changes.  
6. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Edit Community Names or SNMP Traps  
1. From the SNMP page, in the Community Names or SNMP Traps area, select the name or address  
you want to edit.  
2. Select Edit.  
3. Change the required options and select Apply to save the changes.  
4. Select OK.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
187  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP  
Delete Community Names or SNMP Traps  
1. From the SNMP page, in the Community Names or SNMP Traps area, select the name or address  
you want to delete.  
2. Select Delete.  
3. Select Yes.  
Note: Changes made to the GET or SET community names for this machine will require  
corresponding GET or SET community name changes for each application which uses the SNMP  
protocol to communicate with this machine (e.g., Xerox CentreWare Web, any third party network  
management applications, etc.).  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
188  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMPv3  
SNMPv3  
SNMPv3 can be enabled to create an encrypted channel for secure machine management.  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select the Properties icon.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Network Settings link, select the SNMP link.  
6. Select the SNMPv3 link. The SNMPv3 page displays.  
7. In the Setup area:  
a. Select the Enable check box to enable SNMPv3 Protocol.  
b. In the Authentication area, enter the required User Name.  
c. Enter a password in the Authentication Password field.  
d. Enter the password again in the Confirm Password field.  
e. For Authentication Algorithm, select either MD5 or SHA.  
f. Enter a password in the Privacy Password field.  
g. Enter the password in the Confirm Password field.  
h. The Privacy Algorithm displays.  
8. Select Apply to save the changes.  
9. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
189  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IP Sec  
IP Sec  
IP Sec (IP Security) is comprised of the IP Authentication Header and IP Encapsulating Security  
Payload protocols that secure IP communications at the network layer of the protocol stack, using both  
authentication and data encryption techniques. The ability to send IP Sec encrypted data to the  
printer is provided by the use of a public cryptographic key, following a network negotiating session  
between the initiator (client workstation) and the responder (printer or server). To send encrypted data  
to the printer, the workstation and the printer have to establish a Security Association with each other  
by verifying a matching password (shared secret) to each other. If this authentication is successful, a  
session public key will be used to send IP Sec encrypted data over the TCP/IP network to the printer.  
Providing additional security in the negotiating process, SSL (Secure Sockets Layer protocols) are used  
to assure the identities of the communicating parties with digital signatures (individualized checksums  
verifying data integrity), precluding password guessing by network sniffers.  
Enable IP Sec  
This procedure requires that you have a Shared Secret available.  
IP Sec cannot be enabled until Secure Connection is enabled on the machine. For instructions, refer to  
Enable Secure Connection.  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select the Properties icon.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Network Security link.  
6. Select the IP Security link. The IP Security page displays.  
7. Click Enable to enable the IP Sec protocol.  
8. Enter the Shared Secret and Confirm Shared Secret.  
9. Select Apply to save the settings. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
10. The IP Sec Current Status confirms the status of the IP Sec protocol.  
11. To change the Shared Secret, click the Change Shared Secret button and enter the new Shared  
Secret information.  
12. Click Apply to save the changes.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
190  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IP Filtering  
IP Filtering  
Overview  
The IP Filtering is a security feature that allows you to control access to Internet Services. IP Filtering  
allows you to prevent unauthorized access by IP (Internet Protocol).  
The IP Filtering feature provides security to the machine, by allowing you to register the IP addresses  
permitted to communicate with the machine. This feature is used to prevent Raw TCP/IP Printing,  
LPR/LPD, HTTP, Fax to PC, IPP, SNMP, and Scan Manager for Network from unauthorized users.  
Enable IP Filtering  
1. At your Workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine into the  
Address bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Click the Properties icon.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User ID admin and Password 1111, and click Login.  
5. Click the Security link.  
6. Click the Network Security link.  
For IPv4 Filtering  
1. Select IPv4 Filtering.  
2. Select the IPv4 Filtering Enable check box.  
3. Enter the IP Address(es) to permit IP addresses to access the device.  
4. Enter the IP address or an IP address range by using an asterisk (*) as a wild-card character. For  
example:  
192.246.238.* is used to reference a subnet of host addresses  
192.246.* is used to reference a wider subnet of host addresses  
192.* is used to reference the widest subnet of host addresses  
5. The ability to filter on a port or ports is also supported. Enter the port information.  
6. Click Apply to accept changes.  
7. Click OK.  
For IPv6 Filtering  
1. Select IPv6 Filtering.  
2. Select the IPv6 Filtering Enable check box.  
3. Enter the IP Address(es) to permit IP addresses to access the device.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
IP Filtering  
4. Enter the IPv6 address in the form of a CIDR convention. Prefix indicates the number of leftmost  
bits to be referenced.  
For example:  
2001:DB8:1234:215:215:99FF:FE04:D345 / 128 is used to reference a complete address.  
2001:DB8:1234:215:215:99FF:FE04:D345 / 64 is used to reference prefix address consisted of  
leftmost 64 bits only.  
2001:DB8:1234:215:215:99FF:: / 80 is used to reference prefix address consisted of leftmost 80  
bits only.  
5. The ability to filter on a port or ports is also supported. Enter the port information.  
6. Click Apply to accept changes.  
7. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Enable MAC Filtering  
1. Select MAC Filtering in the directory tree. The MAC Filtering page displays.  
2. Select the MAC Filtering Enable box.  
3. In the MAC Address to Filter Out area, select Add.  
4. Enter the MAC Address that you want to filter out.  
5. Select Apply to save the changes.  
6. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
192  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
802.1X Authentication  
802.1X Authentication  
This is the procedure to install and setup 802.1X Authentication.  
Overview  
The Xerox machine supports IEEE 802.1X Authentication via Extensible Authentication Protocol (EAP).  
IEEE 802.1X ensures all machines on the network are authenticated and authorized to use the  
network. 802.1X can be enabled for machines connected through wired Ethernet networks.  
The Administrator can configure the machine to use one EAP type. EAP types supported on the  
machine are:  
EAP-MD5  
PEAP  
EAP-MSCHAPv2  
EAP-TLS  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
802.1X authentication must be supported on the network where the machine is connected.  
Ensure that your 802.1X Authentication Server and authentication switch are available on the  
network.  
Create a User Name and Password on your Authentication Server that will be used to authenticate  
the machine.  
Enable 802.1X at the Machine  
1. Press the Machine Status button on the control panel.  
2. Press the Up/Down arrow buttons to highlight Network and press OK.  
3. Enter the Administrator Password using the alphanumerical keypad. The default is 1111.  
4. Press the OK button, the Network Settings menu displays.  
5. Press the Up/Down arrow buttons to select 802.1x and press OK.  
6. Press the Up/Down arrow buttons to select On; press OK.  
7. Press the Up/Down arrow buttons to select one of the following for the Authentication Method:  
EAP-TLS  
EAP-MSCHAPv2  
PEAP  
EAP-MD5  
8. Press OK.  
9. Enter the User Name using the alphanumerical keypad and press OK.  
10. Enter the password using the alphanumerical keypad and press OK.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
802.1X Authentication  
11. The screen will display Saved and the machine will reboot.  
Enable 802.1X Using CentreWare Internet Services  
Authentication via TLS requires a Device Certificate to be configured or uploaded to the machine. For  
instructions, refer to Access the Machine Digital Certificate Management Screen.  
Authentication via PEAP and TLS require a Root Certificate to be uploaded to the machine. For  
instructions refer to Install Root Certificate.  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select the Properties icon.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Network Security link.  
6. Select 802.1X in the directory tree. The 802.1x Security page displays.  
a. For 802.1x Security, select the Enable check box.  
b. From the Authentication Methods area select one of the following methods:  
EAP-MD5  
EAP-MSCHAPv2  
PEAP  
TLS  
7. If you select EAP-MD5, EAP-MSCHAPv2 or PEAP, the Credentials option appears. Enter the  
required details in the Username and Password fields.  
8. If you select PEAP or TLS, the Server Validation option appears. Click the Select Certificate  
button and select the required root certificate to provide server validation.  
9. If you select TLS, the Device Validation option appears. Click the Select Certificate button and  
select the required certificate to provide device validation.  
10. Select the Apply button to accept the changes.  
11. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
194  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Authentication  
Authentication  
Overview  
Administrators can configure the machine so that users must be authenticated via the network before  
they can access Scan to e-mail features.  
The following authentication options can be configured on the machine.  
No Authentication  
When No Authentication is enabled, users can access features without restriction. No Authentication  
is the default configuration for the machine.  
Authentication  
Authentication can be configured to verify that a user accessing the machine is a valid user. The user's  
authentication details are verified either remotely by an external network server, or locally by an  
internal database stored in the machine.  
The Administrator can select one of these environments to provide authentication:  
No Authentication  
Local Authentication  
External Authentication:  
Kerberos (Unix, Linux)  
Kerberos (Windows ADS)  
SMB (Windows ADS)  
LDAP  
Users are required to enter at least a user name and password to access the machine, based on the  
authentication environment.  
Configure Local Authentication  
The System Administrator can set up a list of user accounts that are defined locally on the machine.  
Procedure  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
195  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Authentication  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Authentication link. The Authentication  
page displays.  
6. In the Authentication Method list, select Local Authentication. Ensure User Profile is enabled in  
the Options area.  
7. Select Apply to save the changes.  
8. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Create User Accounts  
1. Ensure the Authentication menu on the left hand side of the CentreWare Internet Services screen  
is selected and click the User Profile link in the directory tree.  
2. Select the Add button.  
a. Select the required Index number for this user.  
a. Enter a name to identify the User in the User Name field.  
b. Enter the login name for the User in the Login ID field.  
c. Enter the password for the User in the Password field.  
d. Re-type the password in the Confirm Password field.  
e. Enter the user’s Fax Number, if required.  
f. Enter the user's e-mail address in the E-mail Address field. Select the Automatically add  
your information to Address Book if you require this feature.  
3. Select Apply to add the new User and return to the User Profile page.  
Edit User Information  
1. In the User Profile area, select the user and then select the Edit button for the user you want to  
edit. The Edit User page displays.  
2. In the Edit User area change the relevant details and select Apply to save the changes and return  
to the User Profile page.  
Remove a User  
1. In the User Profile area, select the user and then select the Delete button for the user you want to  
remove from the list.  
2. Select OK when the confimation message displays.  
Verify Authentication Is Enabled at the Machine  
1. Press the E-mail button.  
2. The Login ID screen appears.  
3. Enter a valid user name and press OK.  
4. Enter a valid password and press OK. You will have access to the feature.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
196  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Authentication  
Configure External Authentication  
Information Checklist  
Before starting ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been performed:  
Ensure that the external network server to provide authentication is functional on your network.  
Refer to your manufacturer's documentation for instructions to complete this task.  
Configure Kerberos (Unix/Linux)  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Click Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Authentication link. The Authentication  
Method page displays.  
6. For Authentication Method select Kerberos (Unix, Linux).  
7. Select Apply.  
8. In the Network Security link, select External Authentication.  
9. Select Kerberos Server.  
10. Select the Add button.  
11. In the Required Information area:  
a. Enter the Realm.  
b. Enter the Server Address and Port Number.  
12. Select Apply to save the changes.  
13. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
14. Follow the steps in Verify Authentication Is Enabled at the Machine to check that you have set up  
authentication correctly.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
197  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Authentication  
Configure Kerberos (Windows ADS)  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Authentication link. The Authentication  
Method page displays.  
6. For Authentication Method select Kerberos (Windows ADS).  
7. Select Apply to accept the changes.  
8. Click OK.  
9. In the Network Security link, select External Authentication.  
10. Select Kerberos Server.  
11. Select the Add button.  
12. In the Required Information area:  
a. Enter the Realm.  
b. Enter the Server Address and Port Number.  
13. Select Apply to save the changes.  
14. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
15. Follow the steps in Verify Authentication Is Enabled at the Machine to check that you have set up  
authentication correctly.  
Configure SMB (Windows ADS)  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Authentication link. The Authentication  
page displays.  
6. Select SMB (Windows ADS).  
7. Select Apply to accept the changes.  
8. Click OK.  
9. In the Network Security link, select External Authentication.  
10. Select SMB Server.  
11. Select the Add button.  
12. In the Required Information area:  
a. Enter the Domain.  
b. Enter the Server Address and Port Number.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
198  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Authentication  
13. Select Apply to save the changes.  
14. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
15. Follow the steps in Verify Authentication Is Enabled at the Machine to check that you have setup  
authentication correctly.  
Configure LDAP  
Enable LDAP Authentication  
1. At your workstation, open the Web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select Properties.  
4. If prompted, enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and Password (1111), and select Login.  
Select Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the Authentication link. The Authentication  
Method screen displays.  
6. Select LDAP.  
7. Select Apply to accept the changes.  
8. Select OK when the acknowledgement message displays.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
199  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Authentication  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
11  
This chapter includes:  
Consumables  
General Care  
Software Update  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Consumables  
Consumables  
Customer-replaceable consumable supplies for this printer include the following:  
Xerox WorkCentre 3215/3225 Standard Capacity Toner Cartridge  
Xerox WorkCentre 3215/3225 High Capacity Toner Cartridge  
Xerox WorkCentre 3215/3225 Standard Capacity Drum Cartridge  
Placing an Order for Xerox Consumables  
Xerox supplies for your printer can be ordered in several ways:  
Contact your local Xerox Representative or reseller. Provide your company name, product number  
and the machine serial number.  
Note: The machine’s serial number is located on the machine’s data plate on the rear cover, is  
accessible from the Machine Status button in the System Setup menu, and also is printed on the  
Configuration report.  
Order supplies online at www.xerox.com.  
Access the Xerox web page via Easy Printer Manager:  
1. Select the printer for which you want to order supplies.  
2. Select the Order Supplies button.  
3. When another window pops up, select Order Supplies. When the Xerox web page for ordering  
supplies appears, place your order.  
Access the Xerox web page via CentreWare: From your printer’s CWIS page, click the Support tab,  
then Support Links on the left navigation panel. Then click the Order Supplies link on the bottom  
of the page to go to the Xerox website and order online.  
WARNING: Use of non-Xerox supplies is not recommended. Use of toner and drum cartridges  
with other than genuine Xerox Toner can affect print quality and printer reliability. Xerox Toner is  
the only toner designed and manufactured under strict quality controls by Xerox for use with this  
specific printer.  
The Xerox Warranty, Service Agreement, and Total Satisfaction Guarantee do not cover damage,  
malfunction, or degradation of performance caused by use of non-Xerox supplies, or the use of  
Xerox supplies not specified for this printer. The Total Satisfaction Guarantee is available in the  
United States and Canada. Coverage could vary outside these areas. Please contact your Xerox  
representative for details.  
202  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Consumables  
Checking the Status of Consumables  
You can check the status of your installed printer consumables at any time.  
From the Machine  
When your toner cartridge is low on toner, the Machine Status light will blink red to let you know it is  
time to order a new Xerox toner cartridge. When the cartridge is empty and needs to be replaced, the  
light will be solid red. When the drum cartridge needs to be replaced, the Machine Status light will be  
red. For each of these conditions, the user interface will also display an error message indicating the  
cartridge status.  
To enable the Low Toner Alert and the Low Image Unit Alert at your machine:  
1. Go to Press the Machine Status button on the control panel.  
2. Use the up/down arrows to select System Setup. Press OK.  
3. Use the up/down arrows to select Maintenance. Press OK.  
4. Use the up/down arrows to select Toner Low Alert. Press OK.  
5. At On press OK. The machine will save the selection. Press the Back button to return to the  
Maintenance menu options list. Use the up/down arrows to select Image U Low Alert. Press OK.  
6. At On press OK. The machine will save the selection. The Machine Status light will now be red  
when the Drum Cartridge needs to be replaced.  
From your PC:  
Use Easy Printer Manager (EPM) to view a supplies status page:  
1. At your PC, open Easy Printer Manager from the Start menu.  
2. Select the printer.  
3. From the Basic mode page (the smaller window), you can see the toner supply level in the Supplies  
tab; select the Paper tab to see what paper is loaded in the machine. If you open EPM in the  
Advanced mode (large window) you will see Supplies Information just below the device picture.  
Note: Use the Switch icon in the EPM header to move between Basic and Advanced modes.  
Use CentreWare Information Services (CWIS) to check supplies status.  
1. Enter the IP Address of the printer in your Internet browser.  
2. If prompted from the CentreWare page, enter the ID (admin) and Password (1111).  
3. Select the Status tab.  
4. Click Supplies in the left navigation pane to see the toner levels and imaging unit levels in the  
printer.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Consumables  
Storage and Handling of Consumables  
The toner and drum cartridges contain components that are sensitive to light, temperature, and  
humidity. Follow the recommendations provided to ensure the optimum performance, highest quality,  
and longest life from your new cartridge.  
Follow the guidelines below for storing and handling consumables:  
Always store cartridges unopened and inside their original package.  
Store the correct side up in a horizontal position (not standing on end).  
Do not store consumables in:  
Temperatures greater than 40°C (104°F).  
Humidity range less than 20% and not greater than 80%.  
An environment with extreme changes in humidity or temperature.  
Direct sunlight or room light.  
Dusty places.  
A vehicle for a long period of time.  
An environment where corrosive gases are present.  
An environment with salty air.  
Do not store consumables directly on the floor.  
Do not touch the surface of the photosensitive drum in the drum cartridge.  
Do not expose the cartridge to unnecessary vibrations or shock.  
Never manually rotate the drum in the drum cartridge, especially in the reverse direction; this can  
cause internal damage and toner spillage.  
When to Order Consumable Supplies  
To avoid print quality problems resulting from worn parts and to maintain your  
machine in top working condition, replace the toner and drum cartridges as  
directed:  
A flashing red warning light and an error message appear on the control  
panel when a toner cartridge or drum cartridge is near its replacement time.  
The Machine Status light flashes red when your toner cartridge or drum cartridge is low and will  
need replacement soon. Check that you have replacements on hand, and order them when the  
warning appears if you do not. It is important to order these items when the messages first  
appear to avoid interruptions to your printing.  
A solid red warning light and an error message appear on the control panel when the toner or  
drum cartridge must be replaced. The Machine Status light becomes solid red to indicate a  
replacement is needed for the toner cartridge or the drum cartridge.  
To replace the toner or drum cartridge follow the instructions provided below or with the consumable.  
WARNING: When replacing consumables, DO NOT remove the covers or guards that are fastened  
with screws. You cannot maintain or service any of the parts that are behind these covers and  
guards. Do NOT attempt any maintenance procedure that is NOT specifically described in the  
documentation supplied with your machine.  
204  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Consumables  
Maintenance Options  
When you install your Xerox WC3215 or WC3225, you can set up a few parameters for maintenance  
features. These options are shown in the chart, and are accessed through these steps:  
1. Press the Machine Status button on the control panel.  
2. Scroll through the options and select System Setup. Press OK.  
3. Scroll to Maintenance and press OK. Scroll through the options and select the maintenance  
features you wish to use.  
Menu Item  
Options  
Supplies Life  
Series of options that enable printing the status of  
specific parts; used by Service or at direction of  
Service.  
Image Manager  
Use this to control the density of all the images that  
are printed. You can select Color images, Black and  
White, or Greyscale, and then set the density for each  
print from -10 to 10.  
Toner Low  
On or Off. When On is selected, the printer will notify  
users that the toner is low via several methods: the  
status light on the control panel, a message at a  
user’s PC, and/or an e-mail sent to the System  
Administrator.  
Image Unit Low  
Serial Number  
On or Off. When On, the printer will notify users that  
the drum cartridge needs replacing via control panel  
light and message. The printer will eventually stop  
printing if the cartridge isn’t replaced.  
When this is selected, the Serial Number will be visible  
in the machine’s user interface.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
General Care  
General Care  
Redistributing Toner  
When the toner cartridge is near the end of its life:  
White streaks on prints or light printing occurs.  
The low toner status indicator appears if the Low Toner Alert feature was enabled in Maintenance  
options. An error message will also appear on the user interface.  
If either condition occurs, you can temporarily improve print quality by redistributing the remaining  
toner in the cartridge. In some cases, white streaks or light printing will still occur even after you have  
redistributed the toner.  
Follow these steps to redistribute the toner in your cartridge and temporarily improve print quality.  
1. Open the front cover.  
2. Pull the toner cartridge out.  
3. Slowly shake the cartridge five or six times to  
distribute the toner evenly inside the cartridge.  
Note: If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with  
a dry cloth and wash clothing in cold water. Hot  
water sets toner into fabric.  
206  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
General Care  
4. Re-install the toner cartridge by inserting it slowly into the machine.  
5. Close the printer cover. When the Machine Status light  
on the control panel is solid green, the machine is  
ready.  
Replacing the Toner Cartridge  
Replace the toner cartridge using the following instructions.  
1. Open the front cover.  
2. Pull out the toner cartridge.  
3. Remove the new toner cartridge from the packaging. Remove the protective materials from the  
cartridge as directed in the packaging labels.  
4. Slowly shake the new cartridge five or six times to  
distribute the toner evenly inside the cartridge.  
Note: If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with a  
dry cloth and wash clothing in cold water. Hot water  
sets toner into fabric.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
General Care  
5. Hold the cartridge by the handle. Slowly insert the  
cartridge into the opening in the machine. Tabs on the  
sides of the cartridge and corresponding grooves within  
the machine will guide the cartridge into the correct  
position until it locks into place.  
6. Close the front cover. Make sure that the door is securely  
closed. When the green machine status light is solid, the  
machine is ready.  
Replacing the Drum Cartridge  
1. Open the front cover.  
2. Pull the toner cartridge out and place it on a clean flat  
surface.  
3. Pull the drum cartridge out slowly.  
4. Remove the new drum cartridge from the packaging.  
Follow directions on the packaging to remove the tape  
and appropriate packaging pieces from the new  
cartridge. Use the handle on the cartridge to avoid  
touching sensitive parts that can be easily damaged.  
CAUTIONS:  
To prevent damage to the drum cartridge, do not  
expose it to light for more than a few minutes. Cover  
it with a piece of paper, if necessary.  
Do not touch the green surface on the underside of the cartridge. Use the handle on the  
cartridge to avoid touching this area.  
208  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
General Care  
5. Hold the drum cartridge by the handle and insert it into  
the machine until it locks into place.  
6. Re-install the toner cartridge.  
7. Close the machine front cover. When the green  
machine status light is solid, the machine is ready.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Care  
Recycling Consumables  
For information on Xerox supplies recycling programs, go to www.xerox.com/gwa.  
Cleaning the Machine  
WARNING: When cleaning the machine do NOT use organic or strong chemical solvents or  
aerosol cleaners. Do NOT pour fluids directly onto any area. Use supplies and cleaning materials  
only as directed in this documentation. Keep all cleaning materials out of the reach of children.  
WARNING: Do not use pressurized air-spray cleaning aids on or in this equipment. Some  
pressurized air-spray containers contain explosive mixtures and are not suitable for use in  
electrical applications. Use of such cleaners can result in a risk of explosion and fire.  
Platen Glass and Constant Velocity Transport (CVT) Glass  
To ensure optimum print quality at all times, clean the glass areas of your machine regularly.  
When you use the automatic document feeder, your documents will pass over the stationary scanner  
using the constant velocity transport (CVT) glass. Any dirt or marks on this piece of glass may:  
Cause lines, streaks, smears and other spots on your copies, faxes or scanned images.  
Show through the document and appear on your scanned images.  
To clean the glass areas of your machine:  
1. Use a lint-free cloth, lightly dampened with a mild  
general cleaning fluid or another suitable non-abrasive  
glass cleaner to clean the platen glass and the constant  
velocity transport glass.  
2. Wipe away any residue with a clean cloth or paper towel.  
3. Use a lint-free cloth, lightly dampened with water to  
clean the underside of the automatic document feeder  
and the constant velocity transport glass cover.  
Control Panel, Automatic Document Feeder, and Output Tray  
Regular cleaning keeps the display, control panel, and other machine areas free from dust and dirt.  
1. Use a soft, lint-free cloth, lightly dampened with water.  
2. Wipe clean the entire area of the control panel, including the display.  
3. Wipe clean the automatic document feeder, output tray, paper tray, and other outside areas of  
your machine.  
4. Remove any residue with a clean cloth or paper towel.  
210  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
General Care  
Internal Areas  
During the printing process, paper, toner, and dust particles can accumulate inside the machine. This  
can cause print quality problems, such as toner specks or smearing. Cleaning inside the machine clears  
and reduces these problems.  
1. Turn the machine off and unplug the power cord. Wait for  
the machine to cool down.  
2. Open the front cover of the machine.  
3. Pull the toner cartridge out and place it on a clean  
flat surface. Then remove the drum cartridge and  
place it on a clean flat surface. With a dry, lint-free  
cloth, wipe away any dust and spilled toner from the  
cartridge area inside the machine.  
CAUTION: While cleaning the inside of the  
machine, be careful not to damage any inside parts. Do not use solvents such as benzene or  
thinner to clean. Printing quality problems can occur and damage can be caused to the machine.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Care  
4. Re-install the drum cartridge and then the toner  
cartridge. Tabs on the sides of the cartridge and  
corresponding grooves within the machine will guide  
the cartridge into the correct position until each locks  
into place.  
5. Close the front cover.  
6. Plug in the power cord and turn on the machine. When  
the green machine status light is solid, the machine is  
ready.  
Moving the Machine  
When moving the machine, do not tilt or turn it upside down as the inside of the machine may  
become contaminated with toner, which can cause damage to the machine or adversely affect  
print quality.  
When moving the machine, make sure to hold the machine securely from the bottom.  
212  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Software Update  
Software Update  
Xerox is continually seeking to improve its products. A software revision may become available to  
improve the functionality of your machine. The Software Upgrade feature allows the customer to  
upgrade the machine software without needing a Customer Service Representative to be present.  
The Software Upgrade Process  
The software can be upgraded over a network connection using CentreWare Internet Services.  
Any jobs in the printer queue must be allowed to complete or be deleted before initiating a  
software upgrade.  
This procedure will prevent further jobs from being received until the upgrade has completed.  
All configured network settings and installed options will be retained by the machine after the  
software upgrade process.  
Process Checklist  
Before starting please ensure that the following items are available and/or the tasks have been  
performed:  
Obtain the new software upgrade file for your machine from the www.xerox.com web site or from  
your Xerox Customer Support Representative. The upgrade file will have an extension of .hd.  
Download the upgrade file to a local or network drive. You will be able to delete the file after the  
upgrade procedure.  
It is important to obtain the correct upgrade file for your particular model of machine. For  
instructions to determine which model of machine you have, refer to Installation and Setup.  
TCP/IP and HTTP protocols must be enabled on the machine so that the machine web browser  
can be accessed.  
Procedure  
Note: The upgrade process should take less than 10 minutes unless there are network issues.  
1. At your workstation, open the web browser and enter the IP Address of the machine in the  
Address Bar.  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Select the Login link at the top of the screen. Enter the Administrator User Name (admin) and  
Password (1111), and select Login.  
4. Select Properties.  
5. In the Security link on the left hand side, select the System Security link.  
6. Select the Feature Management link in the directory tree.  
7. Select the Firmware Upgrade Enable box.  
8. Click Apply to save the changes.  
9. Select the Support tab.  
10. In the Firmware Upgrade link select the Upgrade Wizard button.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Software Update  
11. The Firmware Upgrade Wizard screen appears. In the Firmware File area:  
a. Select Browse.  
b. Locate and select the software upgrade .hd file obtained earlier.  
c. Select Open.  
12. Select Next. The firmware will now be verified and display information about the upgrade file.  
13. Select Next to continue. The upgrade should take less than 10 minutes unless there are network  
issues.  
14. Once the machine has completed the upgrade it will reboot automatically. The configuration  
report will print (if enabled). Check the configuration report to verify that the software level has  
changed.  
214  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
12  
This chapter includes:  
Overview  
Clearing Paper Jams  
Error Messages  
Common Problems  
Further Assistance  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Overview  
Overview  
If a problem occurs with your Xerox WorkCentre 3215/3225, messages appear on the control panel  
display to indicate the error. Perform the following problem solving procedure:  
1. Check the display message to see what kind of error has occurred.  
2. Use the information in this section to resolve the problem:  
Error Messages  
Paper Tray Jams  
Automatic Document Feeder  
Common Problems  
Paper Feeding Problems  
Printing Problems  
Copying Problems  
Scanning Problems  
Fax Problems  
Operating System Problems  
3. Press OK on the control panel. If the problem persists, repeat the procedure.  
4. If the problem cannot be resolved, power off and on, and try the job again.  
5. If the problem persists, call for service. When you call for service, provide the service representative  
with the contents of the display message.  
216  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Overview  
Status / Wireless LED  
The color of the Status / Wireless LED located on the control panel indicates the  
machine’s current status. The table below describes the various indicators.  
Note: Some LEDs may not be available, depending on machine configuration.  
LED  
Color  
Status  
Description  
Machine is offline OR  
Status LED  
Off  
On  
Machine is in Power Saver Mode; the green Power Saver  
light (at top right of control panel) will be on.  
None  
Green  
The machine is online and ready to use.  
Blinking  
The machine is warming up.  
The machine is receiving or printing data.  
Door is opened. Close the machine door.  
There is no paper in the tray. Load paper in the tray.  
The machine has stopped due to a major error. Check  
the display message.  
The toner cartridge has reached its estimated end of  
life. Replace the toner cartridge. (See Replacing the  
Toner Cartridge.)  
A drum cartridge has almost reached its estimated  
cartridge life. It is recommended to replace the drum  
cartridge (see Replacing the Drum Cartridge).  
On  
Red  
A minor error has occurred and the machine is waiting  
for the error to be cleared. Check the display message.  
When the problem is cleared, the machine resumes.  
Small amount of toner is left in the cartridge. The  
estimated cartridge life of toner is close. Prepare a  
new cartridge for replacement. You may temporarily  
increase the printing quality by redistributing the  
toner (see Redistributing Toner).  
Blinking  
On  
A paper jam has occurred (see Clearing Paper Jams).  
The machine is connected to a wireless network.  
Orange  
Blue  
On  
Wireless  
Blinking  
The machine is in the process of connecting to a wireless  
network.  
Off  
Machine is disconnected from any wireless network.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing Paper Jams  
Clearing Paper Jams  
Tips for Avoiding Paper Jams  
By selecting the correct media types, most paper jams can be avoided.  
Ensure that the adjustable guides on the paper tray are positioned correctly. (See Loading Paper  
Tray.)  
Do not overload the tray. Ensure that the paper level is below the paper capacity mark on the  
inside of the tray.  
Do not remove paper from the tray while your machine is printing.  
Flex, fan, and straighten paper before loading.  
Do not use creased, damp, or highly curled paper.  
Do not mix paper types in a tray.  
Use only recommended print media. (See Media Types.)  
Ensure that the recommended side of the print media is facing down in the tray, or facing up in  
the Manual Feed Slot, top edge first.  
Do not print duplex output with the rear door open.  
When a paper jam occurs, a warning message appears on the display screen.  
CAUTION: To avoid tearing the paper, pull the jammed paper out slowly and gently. Follow the  
instructions in the following sections to clear the jam.  
Automatic Document Feeder Jams  
When an original gets jammed while passing through the automatic document feeder, a warning  
message appears on the display screen.  
CAUTION: To avoid tearing the document, remove the jammed document slowly and gently.  
Note: To prevent document jams, use the platen glass for thick, thin, or mixed paper-type originals.  
1. Remove any remaining originals from the automatic document feeder.  
2. Open the automatic document feeder cover.  
218  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Clearing Paper Jams  
3. Gently remove the jammed paper from the automatic document feeder. If you do not see paper  
in this area, go to the next step.  
4. Close the cover.  
5. Lift the automatic document feeder and gently pull out  
any jammed original. Close the automatic document  
feeder.  
6. Reload the originals into the automatic document feeder and press the Start button to resume  
the job.  
Paper Tray Jams  
1. Pull out the paper tray.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing Paper Jams  
2. Remove any jammed paper by gently pulling it straight  
out.  
3. Release the two green latches positioned above  
where the paper tray sits.  
4. When the baffle drops down, remove any paper  
from that area of the paper path.  
220  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing Paper Jams  
5. Push the baffle back up in place until the two  
latches click.  
6. Ensure the paper is loaded correctly. Insert the tray  
back into the machine until it snaps into place.  
Printing automatically resumes.  
Manual Feed Slot Jams  
1. If the paper is not feeding properly, pull the paper out of  
the machine.  
2. Close the Manual Feed Slot cover.  
3. Open the machine front cover and then close it.  
4. Re-load the paper in the Manual Feed Slot to resume  
printing.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing Paper Jams  
Clearing Jams Inside the Machine  
CAUTION: Some areas of the machine are hot. Take care when removing paper from the  
machine.  
1. Open the front cover. Pull the toner cartridge out.  
2. Remove the jammed paper by gently pulling it straight  
out.  
3. Reinstall the toner cartridge. Tabs on the sides of the  
cartridge and corresponding grooves within the machine  
will guide the cartridge into the correct position until it  
locks into place.  
4. Close the front cover. Printing automatically resumes.  
222  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing Paper Jams  
Duplex and Exit Area Jams  
1. Open the rear cover of the machine.  
2. Press down and pull out the green latches (and  
attached baffle) on either side of opening.  
Remove any paper you see, working slowly so  
that you don’t tear any pieces or damage  
machine parts.  
3. After removing the paper you see, pull the  
baffle up until the latches click into place.  
4. Close the rear cover. Printing will resume  
automatically.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Error Messages  
Error Messages  
Use the following information to solve problems on the machine. Some messages may not appear on  
the display depending on options or models.  
Message  
Meaning  
Suggested Solutions  
Door is open.  
Close it.  
One of the machine covers is not  
securely latched.  
Close the open cover until it  
locks into place.  
Jam  
at duplex path  
Paper has jammed during duplex  
printing.  
Clear the jam. (See Duplex and  
Exit Area Jams.)  
Jam  
inside machine  
Paper has jammed inside the  
machine.  
Clear the jam. (See Paper Tray  
Jams.)  
Network Problem  
WiFi Connection  
Wireless not connected  
Turn machine off, then on  
again.  
Network Problem:  
IP Conflict  
The network IP address you have  
set is being used by someone else.  
Check the IP address and reset  
it if necessary (See Printing a  
Network Configuration  
Report.).  
Paper Jam  
in Manual Feeder  
Paper has jammed in the Manual  
Feed Slot area.  
Clear the jam. (See Manual  
Feed Slot Jams.)  
Paper Jam in Tray 1  
Paper has jammed in the paper  
tray area.  
Clear the jam. (See Paper Tray  
Jams.)  
Replace  
Toner Cart.  
The toner cartridge has reached  
the end of its lifespan. The printer  
stops printing.  
Replace the toner cartridge.  
(See Replacing the Toner  
Cartridge.)  
Toner is low.  
Order Toner Cart.  
Only a small amount of toner is  
left in the toner cartridge. The  
toner cartridge will need to be  
replaced soon.  
Prepare a new cartridge for  
replacement. You may  
temporarily increase the  
printing quality by  
redistributing the toner. (See  
Redistributing Toner.)  
Invalid  
Toner Cart.  
The toner cartridge you have  
installed is not for your machine.  
Install a new toner cartridge  
designed for your machine.  
Install  
Toner Cart.  
The toner cartridge is not installed.  
Install the toner cartridge. (See  
Replacing the Toner Cartridge.)  
224  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Common Problems  
Common Problems  
The following charts list some conditions that may occur and the recommended solutions. Follow the  
suggested solutions until the problem is corrected. If the problem persists, call for service.  
Paper Feeding Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Paper jams during printing.  
The paper keeps jamming.  
Clear the paper jam. (See Clearing Paper Jams.)  
There is too much paper in the tray. Remove excess paper from the tray.  
If you are printing on special materials, use the Manual Feed Slot.  
An incorrect type of paper is being used. Use only paper that meets the  
specifications required by the machine. (See Media Types.)  
There may be debris inside the machine. Clean the inside of the  
machine. (See Cleaning the Machine.)  
Paper sticks together.  
Check the maximum paper capacity of the tray. (See Media  
Specifications.)  
Make sure that you are using the correct type of paper. (See Media  
Types.)  
Remove paper from the tray and flex or fan the paper.  
Humid conditions may cause some paper to stick together.  
Different types of paper may be stacked in the tray. Load paper of only  
one type, size, and weight.  
Paper does not feed into the  
machine.  
Remove any obstructions from inside the machine.  
Paper has not been loaded correctly. Remove paper from the tray and  
reload it correctly.  
There is too much paper in the tray. Remove excess paper from the tray.  
The paper is too thick. Use only paper that meets the specifications  
required by the machine. (See Media Specifications.)  
If you are printing on special media, use the Manual Feed Slot.  
Transparencies stick together in  
the paper exit.  
Use only transparencies specifically designed for laser printers. Remove  
each transparency as it exits from the machine.  
Envelopes skew or fail to feed  
correctly.  
Ensure that the paper guides are against both sides of the envelopes.  
Feed envelopes one at a time through the Manual Feed Slot.  
The originals keep jamming in  
the automatic document  
feeder.  
If an original does not feed into the machine, the automatic document  
feeder rubber pad may need to be replaced. Contact a service  
representative.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Common Problems  
Printing Problems  
Condition  
Possible Cause  
Suggested Solutions  
The machine does not print.  
The machine is not receiving  
power.  
Check the power cord connections.  
Check the power switch and the  
power source.  
The machine is not selected as  
the default machine.  
Select your machine as your default  
machine in Windows.  
Check the machine for the following:  
The front door is not closed. Close the front door.  
Paper is jammed. Clear the paper jam. (See Paper Tray Jams.)  
No paper is loaded. Load paper.  
The toner or drum cartridge is not installed. Install the toner or drum  
cartridge.  
If a system error occurs, contact your service representative.  
The connection cable between  
the computer and the machine  
is not connected properly.  
Disconnect the machine cable and  
reconnect it.  
The connection cable between  
the computer and the machine  
is defective.  
If possible, attach the cable to  
another computer that is working  
properly and print a job. You can also  
try using a different machine cable.  
The port setting is incorrect.  
Check the Windows printer setting to  
make sure that the print job is sent  
to the correct port. If the computer  
has more than one port, make sure  
that the machine is attached to the  
correct one.  
The machine may be  
configured incorrectly.  
Check the printer driver options to  
ensure that all of the print settings  
are correct.  
The printer driver may be  
incorrectly installed.  
Reinstall the printer software. (See  
Installation and Setup.)  
The machine is malfunctioning.  
Check the display message on the  
control panel to see if the machine is  
indicating a system error. Contact a  
service representative.  
226  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Common Problems  
Condition  
Possible Cause  
Suggested Solutions  
A print job is extremely slow.  
The job may be very complex.  
Reduce the complexity of the page  
or try adjusting the print quality  
settings.  
After 100 consecutive prints the  
device print speed will slow down  
until the current job completes. The  
next job will return to rated speed.  
Half the page is blank.  
The page orientation setting  
may be incorrect.  
Change the page orientation in your  
application. See the printer driver  
help screen.  
The paper size and the paper  
size settings do not match.  
Ensure that the paper size in the  
printer driver settings matches the  
paper in the tray.  
Or, ensure that the paper size in the  
printer driver settings matches the  
paper selection in the software  
application settings you use.  
The machine prints, but the  
text is wrong, garbled, or  
incomplete.  
The machine cable is loose or  
defective.  
Disconnect the machine cable and  
reconnect. Try a print job that you  
have already printed successfully. If  
possible, attach the cable and the  
machine to another computer that  
you know works and try a print job.  
Try a new machine cable.  
The wrong printer driver was  
selected.  
Check the application’s printer  
selection menu to ensure that your  
machine is selected.  
The software application is  
malfunctioning.  
Try printing a job from another  
application.  
The operating system is  
malfunctioning.  
Exit applications and reboot the  
computer. Turn the Xerox machine  
off and back on again.  
Pages print, but they are blank.  
The toner cartridge is defective  
or out of toner.  
Redistribute the toner.  
If necessary, replace the toner  
cartridge.  
The file may have blank pages.  
Check the file to ensure that it does  
not contain blank pages.  
Some parts, such as the  
controller or the board, may be  
defective.  
Contact a service representative.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Common Problems  
Condition  
Possible Cause  
Suggested Solutions  
The machine does not print  
PDF file correctly. Some parts of PDF file and the Acrobat  
graphics, text, or illustrations  
are missing.  
Incompatibility between the  
Printing the PDF file as an image  
may enable the file to print. Turn on  
Print As Image from the Acrobat  
printing options. It will take longer to  
print when you print a PDF file as an  
image.  
products.  
The print quality of photos is  
not good. Images are not clear. very low.  
The resolution of the photo is  
Reduce the photo size. If you  
increase the photo size in the  
software application, the resolution  
will be reduced.  
Before printing, the machine  
emits vapor near the output  
tray.  
Using damp paper can cause  
vapor during printing.  
Load a new batch of paper.  
To avoid the paper absorbing too  
much moisture, do not open  
packages of paper until required.  
The machine does not print  
special- sized paper, such as  
billing paper.  
Paper size and paper size  
setting do not match.  
Set the correct paper size in the  
Custom Paper Size Settings in the  
Paper tab in the Printing Preferences.  
Common PostScript Problems  
The following situations are PS language specific and may occur when several printer languages are  
used.  
Problem  
Possible Cause  
Solution  
PostScript file cannot be printed.  
The PostScript driver may not be  
installed correctly.  
Install the PostScript driver.  
(See Install Printer Software.)  
Print a configuration page and  
verify that the PS version is  
available for printing.  
If the problem persists, contact  
a service representative.  
“Limit Check Error” report prints.  
A PostScript error page prints.  
The print job was too complex.  
You might need to reduce the  
complexity of the page.  
The print job may not be  
PostScript.  
Make sure that the print job is  
a PostScript job. Check to see  
whether the software  
application expected a setup  
or PostScript header file to be  
sent to the machine.  
228  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Common Problems  
Common Windows Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
“File in Use” message appears during installation.  
Exit all software applications. Remove all software  
from the printer’s startup group, then restart  
Windows. Re-install the printer driver.  
“General Protection Fault”, “Exception OE”, “Spool  
32”, or “Illegal Operation” messages appear.  
Close all other applications, reboot Windows and  
try printing again.  
“Fail To Print”, “A printer timeout error occurred”  
messages appear.  
These messages may appear during printing. Wait  
until the machine finishes printing. If the  
message appears in standby mode or after  
printing has been completed, check the  
connection and/or whether an error has occurred.  
Note: Refer to the Microsoft Windows User Guide supplied with your computer for further  
information on Windows error messages.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Common Problems  
Common Linux Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
The machine does not print.  
Check if the printer driver is installed on your system. Open the Unified  
Driver Configurator and switch to the Printers tab in the Printers  
configuration window to look at the list of available machines. Make  
sure that your machine is displayed on the list. If not, open the Add new  
printer wizard to set up your machine.  
Check if the machine is started. Open the Printers configuration  
window and select your machine from the printer list. Look at the  
description in the Selected printer pane. If its status contains Stopped,  
press the Start button. Normal operation of the machine should be  
restored. The “stopped” status might be activated if problems in  
printing occurred. For instance, this could be an attempt to print a  
document when the port is being used by a scanning application.  
Ensure the port is not busy. Since functional components of the  
machine (printer and scanner) share the same I/O interface (port),  
simultaneous access of different “consumer” applications to the same  
port is possible. To avoid possible conflicts, only one of them at a time is  
allowed to gain control over the machine. The other “consumer” will  
encounter a “device busy” response. You should open the Ports  
Configuration window and select the port assigned to your machine. In  
the Selected port pane you can see if the port is occupied by some  
other application. If this is the case, you should either wait for  
completion of the current job or press the Release port button.  
Check if your application has a special print option such as “-oraw”. If  
“-oraw” is specified in the command line parameter, then remove it to  
print properly. For Gimp front-end, select the “print” -> “Setup printer”  
and edit command line parameters in the command item.  
The machine does not print  
whole pages, and output is  
printed on half the page.  
It is a known problem that occurs on version 8.51 or earlier of  
Ghostscript, 64-bit Linux OS.The problem is solved in AFPL Ghostscript v.  
8.52 or above. Download the latest version of AFPL Ghostscript from  
http://sourceforge.net/projects/ghostscript/ and install it to solve this  
problem.  
Cannot scan via Gimp  
Front-end.  
Check if the Gimp Front-end has Xsane: Device dialog. on the Acquire  
menu. If not, you should install the Xsane plug-in for Gimp on the your  
computer. You can find the Xsane plug-in package for Gimp on the Linux  
distribution CD or the Gimp home page. For detailed information, refer  
to the ‘Help for Linux’ distribution CD or the Gimp Front-end application.  
If you wish to use another kind of scan application, refer to the  
application’s Help files.  
230  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Common Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Error message “Cannot open  
port device file” displays when  
printing a document.  
Avoid changing print job parameters (via LPR GUI, for example) while a  
print job is in progress. Known versions of CUPS server break the print  
job whenever print options are changed and then try to restart the job  
from the beginning. Since Unified Linux Driver locks the port while  
printing, the abrupt termination of the driver keeps the port locked and  
unavailable for subsequent Print jobs. If this situation occurs, try to  
release the port by selecting Release port in Port configuration  
window.  
The machine does not appear  
on the scanners list.  
Ensure your machine is attached to your computer, connected properly  
via the USB port, and is turned on.  
Ensure the scanner driver for your machine is installed on your system.  
Open Unified Linux Driver configurator, switch to Scanners  
configuration, then press Drivers. Make sure that a driver with a name  
corresponding to your machine's name is listed in the window.  
Ensure the port is not busy. Since functional components of the  
machine (printer and scanner) share the same I/O interface (port),  
simultaneous access of different “consumer” applications to the same  
port is possible. To avoid possible conflicts, only one of them at a time is  
allowed to gain control over the machine. The other “consumer” will  
encounter “device busy” response. This usually happens when starting a  
scan procedure. An appropriate message box appears.  
To identify the source of the problem, open the Ports configuration and  
select the port assigned to your scanner, port's symbol /dev/mfp0  
corresponds to LP:0 designation displayed in the scanners’ options,  
/dev/mfp1 relates to LP:1, and so on. USB ports start at /dev/mfp4, so  
scanner on USB:0 relates to /dev/mfp4 respectively and so forth  
sequentially. In the Selected port pane, you can see if the port is  
occupied by another application. If this is the case, you should either  
wait for completion of the current job or press the Release port button.  
The machine does not scan.  
Ensure a document is loaded into the machine, ensure your machine is  
connected to the computer.  
Note: Refer to the Linux User Guide supplied with your computer for further information on Linux  
error messages.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Common Problems  
Common Macintosh Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
The machine does not print  
PDF files correctly. Some parts  
of graphics, text, or illustrations  
are missing.  
Printing the PDF file as an image may enable the file to print. Turn on  
Print As Image from the Acrobat printing options.  
It will take longer to print when you print a PDF file as an image.  
The document has printed, but  
the print job has not  
Update your MAC OS to OS X 10.5 or higher.  
disappeared from the spooler in  
Mac OS X10.3.2.  
Some letters are not displayed  
normally during the cover page  
printing.  
Mac OS cannot create the font during the cover page printing. The  
English alphabet and numbers are displayed normally on the cover  
page.  
Note: Refer to the Macintosh User Guide supplied with your computer for further information on  
Macintosh error messages.  
Print Quality Problems  
If the inside of the machine is dirty or paper has been loaded improperly, there might be a reduction in  
print quality. See the table below to clear the problem.  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Light or faded print  
If a vertical white streak or faded area appears on the page, the toner supply is low.  
You may be able to temporarily extend the toner cartridge life. (See Redistributing  
Toner.) If this does not improve the toner quality, install a new toner cartridge.  
The paper may not meet paper specifications; for example, the paper may be too  
moist or rough. (See Media Guidelines.)  
If the entire page is light, the print resolution setting is too low or the toner save  
mode is on. Adjust the print resolution and turn the toner save mode off. See the  
help screen of the printer driver.  
A combination of faded or smeared defects may indicate that the toner cartridge  
needs replacing. (See Replacing the Toner Cartridge.)  
Toner specks  
The paper may not meet specifications; for example, the paper may be too moist or  
rough. (See Media Guidelines.)  
The transfer roller may be dirty. Clean the inside of your machine. (See Cleaning the  
Machine.)  
The paper path may need cleaning. (See Cleaning the Machine.)  
232  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Common Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Dropouts  
If faded areas, generally rounded, occur randomly on the page:  
A single sheet of paper may be defective. Try reprinting the job.  
The moisture content of the paper is uneven or the paper has moist spots on its  
surface. Try a different brand of paper. (See Media Guidelines.)  
The paper is damaged. The manufacturing processes can cause some areas to reject  
toner. Try a new ream or brand of paper.  
Change the printer option and try again. Go to Printing Preferences, click Paper tab,  
and set type to Thick.  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
If these steps do not correct the problem, contact a service representative.  
White Spots  
Vertical lines  
Background  
Toner smear  
If white spots appear on the page:  
The paper is too rough and dirt from the paper falls to the inner areas of the  
machine on to the transfer roller. Clean the inside of your machine. (See Cleaning  
the Machine.)  
The paper path may need cleaning. (See Cleaning the Machine.)  
If black vertical streaks appear on the page, isolate the problem to copying, printing or  
scanning and perform the following:  
If copying or scanning, check the CVT glass and platen glass and if necessary clean  
using a lint-free cloth.  
If copying or printing, the drum cartridge inside the machine has probably been  
scratched. Remove the drum cartridge and install a new one. (See Replacing the  
Drum Cartridge.)  
If white vertical streaks appear on the page:  
If the amount of background shading becomes unacceptable:  
Change to a lighter weight paper. (See Media Specifications.)  
Check the environmental conditions: very dry conditions or a high level of humidity  
(higher than 80% RH) can increase the amount of background shading.  
Remove the old toner cartridge and install a new one. (See Replacing the Toner  
Cartridge.)  
If toner smears on the page:  
Clean the inside of the machine. (See Cleaning the Machine.)  
Check the paper type and quality. (See Media Guidelines.)  
Remove the toner cartridge and install a new one. (See Replacing the Toner  
Cartridge.)  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Common Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Vertical repetitive  
defects  
If marks repeatedly appear on the printed side of the page at even intervals:  
The toner cartridge may be damaged. Run a few prints through the machine and if  
you still have the problem, remove the toner cartridge and install a new one. (See  
Replacing the Toner Cartridge.)  
Parts of the machine may have toner on them. If the defects occur on the back of  
the page, the problem will likely correct itself after a few more pages.  
The fusing assembly may be damaged. Contact a service representative.  
Background scatter Background scatter results from bits of toner randomly distributed on the printed page.  
The paper may be too damp. Load a new batch of paper. Do not open packages of  
paper until necessary so that the paper does not absorb too much moisture.  
If background scatter occurs on an envelope, change the printing layout to avoid  
printing over areas that have overlapping seams on the reverse side. Printing on  
seams can cause problems.  
A
If background scatter covers the entire surface area of a printed page, adjust the  
print resolution through your software application or using the printer driver options.  
Misformed  
characters  
If characters are improperly formed and producing hollow images, the paper stock  
may be too slick. Try different paper. (See Media Guidelines.)  
If characters are improperly formed and producing a wavy effect, the scanner unit  
may need service. Contact a service representative.  
Page skew  
Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.  
Check the paper type and quality. (See Media Guidelines.)  
Ensure that the guides are not too tight or too loose against the paper stack. (See  
Loading Paper.)  
Curl or wave  
Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.  
Check the paper type and quality. Both high temperature and humidity can cause  
paper curl. (See Media Guidelines.)  
Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also try rotating the paper 180 degrees in  
the tray.  
Change the printer option and try again. Go to Printing Preferences, click Paper tab,  
and set type to Thin.  
If job is simplex, leave the rear cover open. Prints will be delivered face up.  
Note: The rear cover output can only be used for simplex jobs one sheet at a time. Do  
not leave rear cover open for duplex jobs.  
234  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Common Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Wrinkles or creases  
Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.  
Check the paper type and quality. (See Media Guidelines.)  
Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also try rotating the paper 180 degrees in  
the tray.  
Back of printouts  
are dirty  
Check for leaking toner. Clean the inside of the machine. (See Cleaning the Machine.)  
Solid Black pages  
The toner cartridge may not be installed properly. Remove the cartridge and reinsert  
it.  
The toner cartridge may be defective. Remove the toner cartridge and install a new  
one.  
The machine may require repair. Contact a service representative.  
Loose toner  
Clean the inside of the machine.  
Check the paper type and quality. (See Media Guidelines.)  
Remove the toner cartridge and install a new one. (See Replacing the Toner  
Cartridge.)  
The machine may require repair. Contact a service representative.  
Character Voids  
Character voids are white areas within parts of characters that should be solid black:  
If you are using transparencies, try another type of transparency. Because of the  
composition of transparencies, some character voids are normal.  
You may be printing on the wrong surface of the paper. Remove the paper and turn  
it around.  
The paper may not meet paper specifications.  
A
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Common Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Horizontal stripes  
If horizontally aligned black lines, stripes, streaks or smears appear:  
The toner cartridge may be installed improperly. Remove the cartridge and reinsert  
it.  
The toner cartridge may be defective. Remove the toner cartridge and install a new  
one. (See Replacing the Toner Cartridge.)  
If the problem persists, the machine may require repair. Contact a service  
representative.  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
A a B b C  
An unknown image  
repetitively  
appears on a few  
sheets or loose  
toner, light print, or  
contamination  
occurs.  
Your machine is probably being used at an altitude of 1,500 m (4,921 ft) or above.  
The high altitude may affect the print quality, such as loose toner or light imaging.  
Change the correct altitude setting to your machine. (See Machine Settings.)  
Copying Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Copies are too light  
or too dark.  
Use Darkness in Copy feature to lighten or darken the copies. (See Copying.)  
Smears, lines, marks,  
or spots appear on  
copies.  
If the defects are on the original, use Darkness in Copy feature to lighten the  
background of your copies. (See Copying.)  
If there are no defects on the original, clean the scanner unit. (See Cleaning the  
Machine.)  
If the defect occurs when using the automatic document feeder, clean the CVT  
glass using a lint-free cloth.  
Copy image is  
skewed.  
Ensure that the original is face down on the platen glass and not skewed.  
Ensure that the original is face up in the automatic document feeder and just  
touching the guides.  
Check that the copy paper is loaded correctly.  
The transfer roller may be dirty. Clean the inside of your machine.  
Blank copies.  
Ensure that the original is face down on the platen glass or face up in the  
automatic document feeder. If the problem continues, contact a service  
representative.  
Image rubs off the  
copy easily.  
Replace the paper in the tray with paper from a new package.  
In high humidity areas, do not leave paper in the machine for extended periods of  
time.  
236  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Common Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Frequent copy paper  
jams occur.  
Fan the stack of paper, then turn it over in the tray. Replace the paper in the tray  
with a fresh supply. Check/adjust the paper guides, if necessary.  
Ensure that the paper is the proper paper weight and type.  
Check for copy paper or pieces of copy paper remaining in the machine after a  
paper jam has been cleared.  
Toner cartridge  
produces fewer  
copies than  
Your originals may contain pictures, solids, or heavy lines. For example, your  
originals may be forms, newsletters, books, or other documents that use more  
toner.  
expected before  
running out of toner.  
The automatic document feeder may be left open while copies are being made.  
Turn the machine off and back on.  
Scanning Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
The scanner does not  
work.  
Make sure that you place the original to be scanned face down on the platen  
glass, or face up in the automatic document feeder.  
There may not be enough available memory to hold the document you want to  
scan.  
Check that the scanner is configured correctly.  
Check that the machine cable is connected properly.  
Make sure that the machine cable is not defective. Switch the cable with a known  
good cable. If necessary, replace the cable.  
The unit scans very  
slowly.  
If the machine is printing received data, wait to scan your document after the  
received data has been printed.  
Keep in mind that graphics are scanned more slowly than text.  
Fax Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
No dial tone.  
Check that the phone line is properly connected.  
Check that the phone socket on the wall is working by plugging in another phone.  
The numbers stored  
in memory do not  
dial correctly.  
Make sure that the numbers are stored in memory correctly. To check, print an  
Address Book list.  
The original does  
not feed into the  
machine.  
Make sure that the paper is not wrinkled and you are inserting it correctly.  
Check that the original is the right size, not too thick or thin.  
Make sure that the automatic document feeder is firmly closed.  
The automatic document feeder rubber pad may need to be replaced. Contact a  
service representative.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Common Problems  
Condition  
Suggested Solutions  
Faxes are not  
received  
automatically.  
The receiving mode should be set to fax.  
Make sure that there is paper in the tray.  
Check to see if the display shows any error message and follow the instructions to  
remedy the problem.  
The machine does  
not send.  
Make sure that the original is loaded in the automatic document feeder or on the  
platen glass.  
Check the fax machine to which you are sending your fax to see if it can receive  
your fax.  
Try the job again later; the line may have a fault or be busy.  
The incoming fax  
has blank spaces or  
is of poor quality.  
The fax machine sending you the fax may be faulty.  
A noisy phone line can cause line errors.  
Check your machine by making a copy.  
The toner cartridge may be empty. Replace the toner cartridge. (See Replacing the  
Toner Cartridge.)  
Some of the words  
on an incoming fax  
are stretched.  
The fax machine sending the fax had a temporary document jam.  
There are lines on  
the originals you  
sent.  
Check your scanner unit for contamination or debris and clean it. (See Cleaning the  
Machine.)  
The machine dials a  
number, but the  
connection with the  
other fax machine  
fails.  
The other fax machine may be turned off, out of paper, or cannot answer  
incoming calls. Speak with the other machine operator and ask her/him to solve  
the problem.  
Faxes do not store in  
memory.  
There may not be enough memory space to store the fax. If the display indicating  
the memory status shows, delete any faxes you no longer need from the memory,  
and then try to store the fax again.  
Call for service.  
Blank areas appear  
at the bottom of  
each page or on  
other pages, with a  
small strip of text at  
the top.  
You may have chosen the wrong paper settings in the user option setting. For  
details about paper settings refer to Installation and Setup.  
238  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Further Assistance  
Further Assistance  
For any additional help visit our customer web site at www.xerox.com or contact the Xerox Support  
Center quoting the machine serial number.  
Xerox Support Center  
If a fault cannot be resolved by following the display instructions, see Error Messages. If the difficulty  
persists, contact the Xerox Support Center. The Xerox Support Center will want to know the nature of  
the problem, the machine serial number, the fault code (if any), and the name and location of your  
company.  
Locating the Serial Number  
The serial number is located on the data plate on the rear cover of the machine.  
The serial number is also listed on the Configuration report under the Device Profile heading. See below  
to print a Configuration report.  
Printing a Machine Report  
At the machine, you can print several types of reports on the machine's information and activity.  
1. Press Machine Status on the control panel.  
2. Press the up/down arrows to scroll to Information Pages and press OK.  
3. Scroll to select the report you want to print. Options are:  
Configuration, Demo Page, Network Configuration, Supplies Info, Usage Counter, Fax  
Received, Fax Sent, Scheduled Jobs, Fax Confirm, E-mail Sent, Junk Fax, PCL Font, PS Font,  
Epson Font, Address Book.  
4. Press OK.  
5. Select Yes at the Print? prompt and press OK.  
From a networked PC, you can find your machine’s serial number, print a configuration report, and  
browse the status. To get to CentreWare Internet Services:  
Open a web browser at your networked computer.  
Enter the machine's IP address in the browser address window.  
CentreWare Internet Services opens to the Home page, where you can see the Serial Number on  
the left.  
To print reports, select Information > Print Information. Select and print the report you need.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Further Assistance  
240  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
13  
This chapter includes:  
Machine Specifications  
Feature Specifications  
Network Environment  
System Requirements  
Electrical Specifications  
Environmental Specifications  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Machine Specifications  
Machine Specifications  
Machine Configurations  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI  
WorkCentre 3225 DN  
WorkCentre 3225DNI  
Hardware  
Configuration  
600 mHz Processor  
256 MB Memory  
Automatic Document  
Feeder  
Paper Tray, Manual Feed  
Slot  
600 mHz Processor  
256 MB Memory  
Internal Duplex Unit  
Automatic Document Feeder  
Paper Tray and Manual Feed Slot  
Machine Size  
(width x depth x  
height)  
15.8 x 14.2 x 14.4 inches  
(401 x 362 x 367 mm)  
Machine Weight  
24.5 lbs (11.1 kg)  
24.9 lbs (11.3 kg)  
Net (with  
consumables)  
Access  
From the front  
Up to 29 ppm on Letter  
Speed: Simplex  
Up to 27 ppm on Letter  
Up to 26 ppm on A4  
Up to 28 ppm on A4  
Speed: Duplex  
Manual  
Automatic  
Up to 13 ppm on Letter  
Up to 12 ppm on A4  
First Print Out Time  
Warm Up Time  
As fast as 8.5 seconds from Ready/Standby  
From Power Saver Mode: Less than 14 seconds  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Machine Specifications  
Media Specifications  
Main Paper Tray 1  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI / 3225DN / DNI  
250 sheets 20 lb (80 g/m²) paper  
Capacity: Main Tray  
Media Types  
Plain paper, bond  
Media Weights  
Media Sizes  
16 - 43 lb (60 to 163 g/m²)  
Length: min 4.13 inches - max 14 inches (148 - 356 mm)  
Width: min: 5.85 inches max 8.5 inches (105 - 216 mm)  
Letter: 8.5 x 11 inches  
Legal: 8.5 x 14 inches  
A4, A5, A6, Folio, Oficio, ISO B5 (176 x 250 mm), JIS B5 (182 x 257  
mm), Executive: 7.25 x 10.5 inches (184.2 x 266.7 mm)  
Manual Feed Slot  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI / 3225DN / DNI  
Capacity  
1 sheet  
Media Types  
Bond paper, Transparency, Envelope, Labels, Card Stock, Thick,  
Thin, Cotton, Color, Pre-printed, Recycled, Archive  
Media Weights  
16 - 58 lb (60 to 220 g/m²)  
Media Size Range  
Length min 5.0 inches - max 14 inches (127 - 356 mm)  
Width min 3.0 inches - max 8.5 inches (76 - 216 mm)  
Including Envelope Monarch/Com 10/DL/C5/C6, A4, A5, A6,  
Executive, Folio, Oficio, ISO B5, JIS B5, Letter, Legal  
Duplex Unit  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3225DN / DNI Only  
Media Weights  
Media Sizes  
16 - 32 lb (60 to 120 g/m²)  
A4, Letter, Oficio, Folio, Legal  
Plain Paper, Thin, Thick, Recycled, Bond  
Media Types  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Machine Specifications  
Automatic Document Feeder  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI  
WorkCentre 3225DN / DNI  
Capacity  
40 sheets of 20 lb (80 g/m²) bond paper  
Paper Weights  
Paper Sizes  
16 - 28 lb (60 to 105 g/m²)  
Width: 5.8 - 8.5 inches (148 - 216 mm)  
Length: 5.8 - 14.0 inches (148 - 356 mm)  
Automatic Document Feeder 17 ipm  
Speed (A4 mono)  
17 ipm  
Output Tray  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI / WorkCentre 3225DN / DNI  
Top Output Tray Capacity  
120 sheets of 20 lb. / 80 g/m² bond paper  
Delivered face down  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
244  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Feature Specifications  
Feature Specifications  
Print Features  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI  
WorkCentre 3225DN / DNI  
Speed  
Letter: 27 ppm one-sided  
A4: 26 ppm  
Letter: 29 ppm one-sided  
A4: 28 ppm  
Two-sided Letter: 13 ppm  
Two-sided A4: 12 ppm  
Maximum Print Area  
Maximum Print Resolution  
Toner Cartridge Yield  
8.5 x 14 inches US Legal  
(216 mm x 356 mm)  
True 600 x 600 dpi  
Up to 1200 x 1200 effective output  
Standard Toner Cartridge, Average Yield: 1000 standard prints  
High Yield Cartridge: Average Yield: 3000 standard prints  
Yield from Starter Cartridge supplied with machine: 1500 standard prints  
Standard Printer Memory  
Compatibility  
256 MB  
Windows PC / MAC / Linux / Unix  
SPL, PCL5e, PCL6, Postscript 3  
PDL / PCL  
Fax Features  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI / WorkCentre 3225DN / DNI  
Fax Transmission Speed  
Telephone Line Type  
33.6 Kbps  
Standard public analogue switched telephone line or equivalent  
PSTN, PABX  
Communication Standard  
Maximum Resolution Capability  
Effective Scanning Width  
Maximum Print Width  
ITU-T, G3, ECM  
300 x 300 dpi  
8.5 inches (216 mm)  
8.5 inches (216 mm)  
Connection Approvals  
EU/EEA: certified to TBR21  
USA: approved to FCC Pt 68  
Canada: approved to DOC CS-03  
Other countries: certified to national PTT standards  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Feature Specifications  
Copy Features  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI / WorkCentre 3225DN / DNI  
First Copy Out Time  
In Standby Mode:  
From ADF: less than 15 seconds  
From Platen: less than 14 seconds  
In Power Save Mode: 42 seconds  
Zoom Range  
25% - 400%  
From platen and ADF  
Maximum Resolution  
Multi Copy  
600 x 600 dpi  
1 - 99  
Copy Speeds  
Single original, multiple copies: 28 cpm  
Multiple originals, multiple copies: 17 ipm  
Scan Features  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI, 3225DN / DNI  
Maximum Document Width  
Effective Scan Width  
8.5 inches (216 mm)  
8.2 inches (208 mm)  
Maximum Resolution  
Up to 1200 x 1200 dpi optical  
Enhanced: up to 4800 x 4800 dpi interpolated  
Scan to PC via USB or network  
connection  
Yes  
Scan Speeds  
Scan Send Modes  
Grayscale  
6 - 17 ipm, depending on scan mode  
Black and White, Grayscale, and Color  
256 levels  
Compatibility  
TWAIN Standard  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Environment  
Network Environment  
WorkCentre  
3225DNI  
Item  
WorkCentre 3215NI  
WorkCentre 3225DN  
Network interface  
Ethernet  
10/100/1000  
Base-TX  
802.11b/g/nWireless  
LAN  
Ethernet  
10/100/1000  
Base-TX  
Ethernet  
10/100/1000  
Base-TX  
802.11b/g/nWireless  
LAN  
Print from USB  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Apple Airprint®  
Google Cloud Print®  
Network operating  
system  
Windows® 7 & 8, XP, Server 2003. Server 2008, Vista, Server 2008 R2  
Various Linux OS  
Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.9  
Unix  
Network protocols  
TCP/IPv4, TPC/IPv6  
DHCP, BOOTP  
DNS, WINS, DDNS, Bonjour, SLP, UPnP  
Standard TCP/IP Printing (RAW), LPR, IPP, WSD  
SNMPv1/v2c/v3, HTTP, IPSec  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Requirements  
System Requirements  
Microsoft® Windows®  
Operating  
CPU  
Free HDD  
Space  
RAM  
System  
Windows Server® Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz)  
2003 (32/64 bit)  
128 MB (512  
MB)  
1.25 GB to 2 GB  
Windows Server® Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz (Pentium IV 2 GHz)  
2008 (32/64 bit)  
512 MB (2 GB)  
10 GB  
Windows Vista®  
(32/64 bit)  
Intel® Pentium® IV 3 GHz  
512 MB (1 GB)  
15 GB  
Windows® 7 &  
Windows® 8  
(32/64 bit)  
Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz 32-bit or 64-bit processor  
or higher  
1 GB (2 GB)  
16 GB  
Support for DirectX® 9 graphics with 128 MB memory (to enable the Aero theme).  
DVD-R/W Drive  
Windows Server® Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz (x86) or 1.4 GHz (x64)  
512 MB (2 GB)  
10 GB  
2008 R2  
processors (2 GHz or faster)  
(64 bit)  
Windows® XP  
Notes:  
Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz)  
128 MB (256  
MB)  
1.5 GB  
Internet Explorer 6.0 or higher is the minimum requirement for all Windows operating systems.  
Users who have administrator rights can install the software.  
Windows Terminal Services is compatible with your machine.  
Macintosh  
Free  
Operating System  
CPU  
RAM  
HDD  
Space  
Intel® processors  
Mac OS X 10.5  
512 MB (1 GB)  
1 GB  
867 MHz or faster PowerPC G4/ G5  
Intel® processors  
Mac OS X 10.6  
1 GB (2 GB)  
2 GB  
1 GB  
4 GB  
Intel® processors  
Mac OS X 10.7 ~ 10.9  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
248  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Requirements  
Linux  
Free HDD  
Space  
Operating System  
CPU  
RAM  
Fedora 11-19  
Pentium IV 2.4GHz  
512 MB (1 GB) 1 GB  
OpenSuSE® 11.0, 11.1, 11.2, 11.3, 11.4, 12.1, 12.2, (Intel Core™2)  
(2 GB)  
12.3  
Ubuntu 10.04, 10.10, 11.04, 11.10, 12.04, 12.10,  
13.04  
Debian 5.0, 6.0, 7.0, 7.1  
Redhat® Enterprise Linux 5, 6  
SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10, 11  
Mint 13, 14, 15  
Unix  
Free HDD  
Space  
Operating System  
Sun Solaris 9, 10, 11(x86, SPARC)  
Up to 100 MB  
HP-UX 11.0, 11i v1, 11i v2, 11i v3 (PA-RISC, Itanium)  
IBM AIX 5.1, 5.2, 5,3, 5.4, 6.1, 7.1 (Power PC)  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Electrical Specifications  
Electrical Specifications  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI / WorkCentre 3225DN / DNI  
Frequency  
50/60 Hz  
Electrical Voltage  
110 - 127 VAC & 220 - 240 VAC  
Average Power Consumption  
Power Save mode: 1.1 Watts  
Stand By mode: Less than 50 Watts  
Average Operation - Continuous Printing: less than 400 Watts  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
250  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Environmental Specifications  
Environmental Specifications  
Feature  
WorkCentre 3215NI / WorkCentre 3225DN / DNI  
Operating Temperature -  
Between 10 - 32 degrees C (50 - 90 degrees F)  
both printer and consumables  
Relative Humidity  
Acceptable Humidity range: 10 - 80%  
Optimal humidity range: 20 - 70%  
Optimal relative humidity at 28 degrees C (82 F)  
Note: Under extreme environmental conditions, such as 10  
degrees C and 80% relative humidity, defects can occur due to  
condensation.  
Elevation  
For optimum performance, use the printer at elevations below  
3100 M (10,170 ft.).  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Environmental Specifications  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
252  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety  
14  
This chapter includes:  
Electrical Safety  
Operational Safety  
Maintenance Safety  
Environmental, Health, and Safety Contact Information  
Your printer and the recommended supplies have been designed and tested to meet strict safety  
requirements. Attention to the following information ensures the continued safe operation of your  
Xerox printer.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Electrical Safety  
Electrical Safety  
General Guidelines  
WARNING: Unauthorized alterations, which may include the addition of new functions or  
connection of external machines, may impact the machine certification. Please contact your  
Xerox representative for more information.  
Do not push objects into slots or openings on the printer. Touching a voltage point or shorting  
out a part could result in fire or electric shock.  
Do not remove the covers or guards that are fastened with screws unless you are installing  
optional equipment and are instructed to do so. Turn off the printer when performing these  
installations. Disconnect the power cord when removing covers and guards for installing  
optional equipment. Except for user-installable options, there are no parts that you can  
maintain or service behind these covers.  
The following are hazards to your safety:  
The power cord is damaged or frayed.  
Liquid is spilled into the printer.  
The printer is exposed to water.  
The printer emits smoke, or the surface is unusually hot.  
The printer emits unusual noise or odors.  
The printer causes a circuit breaker, fuse, or other safety device to activate.  
If any of these conditions occur, do the following:  
1. Turn off the printer immediately.  
2. Disconnect the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3. Call an authorized service representative.  
Power Cord  
Use the power cord supplied with your printer.  
Plug the power cord directly into a properly grounded electrical outlet. Ensure that each end of the  
cord is connected securely. If you do not know if an outlet is grounded, ask an electrician to check  
the outlet.  
WARNING: To avoid risk of fire or electrical shock, do not use extension cords, power strips, or  
power plugs for more than 90 days. When a permanent outlet receptacle cannot be installed, use  
only one factory-assembled extension cord of the appropriate gauge per printer or multifunction  
printer. Always adhere to national and local building, fire, and electrical codes regarding length of  
cord, conductor size, grounding, and protection.  
Do not use a ground adapter plug to connect the printer to an electrical outlet that does not have  
a ground connection terminal.  
254  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Electrical Safety  
Verify that the printer is plugged into an outlet that is providing the correct voltage and power.  
Review the electrical specification of the printer with an electrician if necessary.  
Do not place the printer in an area where people can step on the power cord.  
Do not place objects on the power cord.  
Do not plug or unplug the power cord while the power switch is in the On position.  
If the power cord becomes frayed or worn, replace it.  
To avoid electrical shock and damage to the cord, grasp the plug when unplugging the power cord.  
The power cord is attached to the printer as a plug-in device on the back of the printer. If it is necessary  
to disconnect all electrical power from the printer, disconnect the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
Emergency Turn Off  
If any of the following conditions occur, turn off the printer immediately and disconnect the power  
cord from the electrical outlet. Contact an authorized Xerox service representative to correct the  
problem if:  
The equipment emits unusual odors or makes unusual noises.  
The power cable is damaged or frayed.  
A wall panel circuit breaker, fuse, or other safety device has been tripped.  
Liquid is spilled into the printer.  
The printer is exposed to water.  
Any part of the printer is damaged.  
Laser Safety  
This printer complies with laser product performance standards set by governmental, national, and  
international agencies and is certified as a Class 1 Laser Product. The printer does not emit hazardous  
light because the beam is totally enclosed during all modes of customer operation and maintenance.  
WARNING: Use of controls, adjustments, or performance of procedures other than those  
specified in this manual can result in hazardous radiation exposure.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operational Safety  
Operational Safety  
Your printer and supplies were designed and tested to meet strict safety requirements. These include  
safety agency examination, approval, and compliance with established environmental standards.  
Your attention to the following safety guidelines helps to ensure the continued, safe operation of your  
printer.  
Operational Guidelines  
Do not remove any paper trays while the printer is printing.  
Do not open the doors when the printer is printing.  
Do not move the printer when it is printing.  
Keep hands, hair, neckties, and so on, away from the exit and feed rollers.  
Covers, which require tools for removal, protect the hazard areas within the printer. Do not remove  
the protective covers.  
Ozone Release  
This printer produces ozone during normal operation. The amount of ozone produced is dependent on  
copy volume. Ozone is heavier than air and is not produced in amounts large enough to harm anyone.  
Install the printer in a well-ventilated room.  
For more information in the United States and Canada, go to www.xerox.com/environment. In other  
markets, please contact your local Xerox representative or go to www.xerox.com/environment_europe.  
If you need additional information about ozone, please request the Xerox publication Facts About  
Ozone (part number 610P64653) by calling 1-800-828-6571 in the United States and Canada. In other  
markets, please contact your local Xerox representative.  
Printer Location  
Place the printer on a level, solid, non-vibrating surface with adequate strength to hold its weight.  
To find the weight for your printer configuration, see Machine Specifications.  
Do not block or cover the slots or openings on the printer. These openings are provided for  
ventilation and to prevent overheating of the printer.  
Place the printer in an area where there is adequate space for operation and servicing.  
Place the printer in a dust-free area.  
Do not store or operate the printer in an extremely hot, cold, or humid environment.  
Do not place the printer near a heat source.  
Do not place the printer in direct sunlight to avoid exposure to light-sensitive components.  
Do not place the printer where it is directly exposed to the cold air flow from an air conditioning  
system.  
Do not place the printer in locations susceptible to vibrations.  
256  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Operational Safety  
For optimum performance, use the printer at the elevations specified in Environmental  
Specifications.  
Printer Supplies  
Use the supplies designed for your printer. The use of unsuitable materials can cause poor  
performance and a possible safety hazard.  
Follow all warnings and instructions marked on, or supplied with, the product, options, and  
supplies.  
Store all consumables in accordance with the instructions given on the package or container.  
Keep all consumables away from the reach of children.  
Never throw toner, print/drum cartridges, or toner containers into an open flame.  
When handling cartridges, for example toner and such, avoid skin or eye contact. Eye contact can  
cause irritation and inflammation. Do not attempt to disassemble the cartridge, which can  
increase the risk of skin or eye contact.  
CAUTION: Use of non-Xerox supplies is not recommended. The Xerox Warranty, Service  
Agreement, and Total Satisfaction Guarantee do not cover damage, malfunction, or degradation  
of performance caused by use of non-Xerox supplies, or the use of Xerox supplies not specified for  
this printer. The Total Satisfaction Guarantee is available in the United States and Canada.  
Coverage could vary outside these areas. Contact your Xerox representative for details.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance Safety  
Maintenance Safety  
Use supplies and cleaning materials only as directed in the Maintenance section of this manual.  
Do not remove covers or guards that are fastened with screws. There are no parts behind these  
covers that you can maintain or service.  
Do not attempt any maintenance procedure that is not specifically described in the  
documentation supplied with your printer.  
Clean with a dry lint-free cloth only.  
WARNING: Aerosol cleaners can be explosive or flammable when used on electromechanical  
equipment.  
Do not burn any consumables or routine maintenance items. For information on Xerox supplies  
recycling programs, go to www.xerox.com/gwa.  
Printer Symbols  
Symbol  
Description  
Warning:  
Indicates a hazard which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.  
Caution:  
Indicates a mandatory action to take in order to avoid damage to the property.  
Hot surface on or in the printer. Use caution to avoid personal injury.  
Do not burn the item.  
Do not expose the imaging unit to light for more than 10 minutes.  
Do not expose the imaging unit to direct sunlight.  
258  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintenance Safety  
Symbol  
Description  
Do not touch the part or area of the printer.  
Warning:  
Wait for the printer to cool for the specified time before touching the fuser.  
This item can be recycled. For details, see Recycling and Disposal.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Environmental, Health, and Safety Contact Information  
Environmental, Health, and Safety Contact  
Information  
For more information on Environment, Health, and Safety in relation to this Xerox product and supplies,  
contact the following customer help lines:  
United States: 1-800 ASK-XEROX  
Canada: 1-800 ASK-XEROX  
Europe: +44 1707 353 434  
For product safety information in the United States, go to www.xerox.com/environment.  
For product safety information in Europe, go to www.xerox.com/environment_europe.  
260  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Regulatory  
15  
This chapter includes:  
Basic Regulations  
Copy Regulations  
Fax Regulations  
Material Safety Data  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Basic Regulations  
Basic Regulations  
Xerox has tested this device to electromagnetic emission and immunity standards. These standards are  
designed to mitigate interference caused or received by this device in a typical office environment.  
United States (FCC Regulations)  
This device has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to  
Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful  
interference in a commercial environment. This device generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency  
energy. If it is not installed and used in accordance with these instructions, it may cause harmful  
interference to radio communications. Operation of this device in a residential area is likely to cause  
harmful interference in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his/her own  
expense.  
If this device does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined  
by turning the device off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or  
more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiver.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is  
connected.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/television technician for help.  
Changes or modifications to this equipment not approved by Xerox can void the authority of the user  
to operate this equipment.  
Note: To ensure compliance with Part 15 of the FCC rules, use shielded interface cables.  
Canada  
This Class A digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe A est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.  
European Union  
The CE mark applied to this device symbolizes Xerox’s declaration of conformity with the  
following applicable Directives of the European Union as of the dates indicated:  
December 12, 2006: Low Voltage Directive 2006/95/EC  
December 15, 2004: Electromagnetic Compatibility Directive 2004/108/EC  
March 9, 1999: Radio & Telecommunications Terminal Equipment Directive 1999/5/EC  
This printer, if used properly in accordance with the user's instructions, is not dangerous for the  
consumer or for the environment.  
262  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Basic Regulations  
To ensure compliance with European Union regulations, use shielded interface cables.  
A signed copy of the Declaration of Conformity for this device can be obtained from Xerox.  
European Union Lot 4 Imaging Equipment Agreement Environmental  
Information  
Environmental Information Providing Environmental Solutions and Reducing Cost  
Introduction  
The following information has been developed to assist users and has been issued in relation to the  
European Union (EU) Energy Related Products Directive, specifically the Lot 4 study on Imaging  
Equipment. This requires manufacturers to improve environmental performance of in scope products  
and supports the EU action plan on energy efficiency.  
In scope products are Household and Office equipment that meet the following criteria.  
Standard monochrome format products with a maximum speed less than 66 A4 images per  
minute  
Standard color format products with a maximum speed less than 51 A4 images per minute  
Environmental Benefits of Duplex Printing  
Most Xerox products have duplex printing, also known as 2-sided printing, capability. This enables you  
to print on both sides of the paper automatically, and therefore helps to reduce the use of valuable  
resources by reducing your paper consumption. The Lot 4 Imaging Equipment agreement requires that  
on models greater than or equal to 40 ppm color or greater than or equal to 45 ppm monochrome the  
duplex function has been auto enabled, during the setup and driver installation. Some Xerox models  
below these speed bands may also be enabled with 2-sided printing settings defaulted on at the time  
of install. Continuing to use the duplex function will reduce the environmental impact of your work.  
However, should you require simplex/1-sided printing, you may change the print settings in the printer  
driver.  
Paper Types  
This product can be used to print on both recycled and virgin paper, approved to an environmental  
stewardship scheme, which complies with EN1 2281 or a similar quality standard. Lighter weight paper  
(60 g/m2), which contains less raw material and thus save resources per print, may be used in certain  
applications. We encourage you to check if this is suitable for your printing needs.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Basic Regulations  
ENERGY STAR  
The ENERGY STAR program is a voluntary scheme to promote the development and purchase of  
energy efficient models, which help to reduce environmental impact. Details on the ENERGY STAR  
program and models qualified to ENERGY STAR can be found at the following Web site:  
www.energystar.gov/index.cfm?fuseaction=find_a_product.showProductGroup&pgw_code=IEQ  
The Xerox WorkCentre 3225 Multifunction Printer is ENERGY STAR® qualified under the Energy STAR  
Program Requirements for Imaging Equipment.  
The ENERGY STAR and ENERGY STAR MARK are registered United States trademarks. The ENERGY  
STAR Imaging Equipment Program is a team effort between U.S., European Union, and Japanese  
governments and the office equipment industry to promote energy-efficient copiers, printers, fax,  
multifunction machines, personal computers, and monitors. Reducing product energy consumption  
helps combat smog, acid rain, and long-term changes to the climate by decreasing the emissions that  
result from generating electricity.  
Xerox ENERGY STAR equipment is preset at the factory. Your printer will be delivered with the timer for  
switching to Power Save Mode from the last copy/print out set at one minute. A more detailed  
description of this feature can be found in the Getting Started section of this guide.  
Power Consumption and Activation Time  
The amount of electricity a product consumes depends on the way the device is used. This product is  
designed and configured to enable you to reduce your electricity costs. After the last print, the device  
switches to Ready mode. In this mode, the device can print again immediately. If the product is not  
used for a period of time, the device switches to a Power Saver mode. In these modes, to enable  
reduced product power consumption, only essential functions remain active.  
The product takes slightly longer to produce the first print after it exits Power Saver mode than it takes  
in Ready mode. This delay is the result of the system waking up from Power Saver mode and is typical  
of most imaging products on the market.  
You can set a longer activation time or completely deactivate the Power Saver mode. This device can  
take longer to switch to a lower energy level.  
To learn more about Xerox participation in sustainability initiatives, go to:  
www.xerox.com/about-xerox/environment/enus.html.  
For additional information on energy or other related topics, please visit:  
www.xerox.com/about-xerox/environment/enus.html. or  
www.xerox.co.uk/about-xerox/environment/engb.html.  
264  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Basic Regulations  
Germany  
Blue Angel  
The Xerox® WorkCentre® 3225 DI/DNI is Blue Angel certified under the RAL-UZ-171 requirements for  
Imaging Equipment.  
RAL, the German Institute for Quality Assurance and Labeling, has awarded this device the Blue Angel  
Environmental Label. This label distinguishes it as a device that satisfies Blue Angel criteria for  
environmental acceptability in terms of device design, manufacture, and operation.  
For more information, go to: www.blauer-engel.de.  
Blendschutz  
Das Gerät ist nicht für die Benutzung im unmittelbaren Gesichtsfeld am Bildschirmarbeitsplatz  
vorgesehen. Um störende Reflexionen am Bildschirmarbeitsplatz zu vermeiden, darf dieses Produkt  
nicht im unmittelbaren Gesichtsfeld platziert werden.  
Larmemission  
Maschinenlärminformatians-Verordnung3 . GPSGV: Der höchste Schalldruckpegel beträgt 70 dB(A)  
oder weniger gemäß EN ISO 7779.  
Importeur  
Xerox GmbH  
Hellersbergstraße 2-4  
41460 Neuss  
Deutschland  
Turkey RoHS Regulation  
In compliance with Article 7 (d). We hereby certify:  
"It is compliant with the EEE Regulation."  
“EEE yönetmeliğine uygundur.”  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Basic Regulations  
Regulatory information for 2.4 Ghz Wireless LAN Module  
This product contains a 2.4 Ghz Wireless LAN radio transmitter module which complies with the  
requirements specified in FCC Part 15, Industry Canada RSS-210 and European Council Directive  
99/5/EC.  
Operation of this device is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause  
harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference  
that may cause undesired operation.  
Changes or modifications to this device not specifically approved by the Xerox Corporation may void  
the user's authority to operate this equipment.  
266  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copy Regulations  
Copy Regulations  
United States  
Congress, by statute, has forbidden the reproduction of the following subjects under certain  
circumstances. Penalties of fine or imprisonment may be imposed on those guilty of making such  
reproductions.  
1. Obligations or Securities of the United States Government, such as:  
Certificates of Indebtedness  
National Bank Currency  
Coupons from Bonds  
Federal Reserve Bank Notes  
Silver Certificates  
Gold Certificates  
United States Bonds  
Treasury Notes  
Federal Reserve Notes  
Fractional Notes  
Certificates of Deposit  
Paper Money  
Bonds and Obligations of certain agencies of the government, such as FHA, etc.  
Bonds (U.S. Savings Bonds may be photographed only for publicity purposes in connection  
with the campaign for the sale of such bonds.)  
Internal Revenue Stamps. If it is necessary to reproduce a legal document on which there is a  
canceled revenue stamp, this may be done provided the reproduction of the document is  
performed for lawful purposes.  
Postage Stamps, canceled or uncanceled. For philatelic purposes, Postage Stamps may be  
photographed, provided the reproduction is in black and white and is less than 75% or more  
than 150% of the linear dimensions of the original.  
Postal Money Orders.  
Bills, Checks, or Drafts of money drawn by or upon authorized officers of the United States.  
Stamps and other representatives of value, of whatever denomination, which have been or  
may be issued under any Act of Congress.  
Adjusted Compensation Certificates for Veterans of the World Wars.  
2. Obligations or Securities of any Foreign Government, Bank, or Corporation.  
3. Copyrighted materials, unless permission of the copyright owner has been obtained or the  
reproduction falls within the fair use or library reproduction rights provisions of the copyright law.  
Further information about these provisions may be obtained from the Copyright Office, Library of  
Congress, Washington, D.C. 20559. Ask for Circular R21.  
4. Certificate of Citizenship or Naturalization. Foreign Naturalization Certificates may be  
photographed.  
5. Passports. Foreign Passports may be photographed.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copy Regulations  
6. Immigration papers.  
7. Draft Registration Cards.  
8. Selective Service Induction papers that bear any of the following registrant information:  
Earnings or Income  
Court Record  
Physical or Mental Condition  
Dependency Status  
Previous Military Service  
Exception: United States military discharge certificates may be photographed.  
9. Badges, Identification Cards, Passes, or Insignia carried by military personnel, or by members of  
the various Federal Departments, such as FBI, Treasure, etc. (Unless photograph is ordered by the  
head of such department or bureau.)  
Reproducing the following is also prohibited in certain states:  
Automobile Licenses  
Drivers’ Licenses  
Automobile Certificates of Title  
The above list is not all inclusive, and no liability is assumed for its completeness or accuracy. In case of  
doubt, consult your attorney.  
For more information about these provisions contact the Copyright Office, Library of Congress,  
Washington, D.C. 20559. Ask for Circular R21.  
Canada  
Parliament, by stature, has forbidden the reproduction of the following subjects under certain  
circumstances. Penalties of fine or imprisonment may be imposed on those guilty of making such  
reproductions.  
Current bank notes or current paper money.  
Obligations or securities of a government or bank.  
Exchequer bill paper or revenue paper.  
The public seal of Canada or of a province, or the seal of a public body or authority in Canada, or  
of a court of law.  
Proclamations, orders, regulations or appointments, or notices thereof (with intent to falsely cause  
same to purport to have been printed by the Queens Printer for Canada, or the equivalent printer  
for a province).  
Marks, brands, seals, wrappers, or designs used by or on behalf of the Government of Canada or of  
a province, the government of a state other than Canada or a department, board, Commission or  
agency established by the Government of Canada or of a province or of a government of a state  
other than Canada.  
Impressed or adhesive stamps used for the purpose of revenue by the Government of Canada or  
of a province or by the government of a state other than Canada.  
10. Documents, registers or records kept by public officials charged with the duty of making or issuing  
certified copies thereof, where the copy falsely purports to be a certified copy thereof.  
268  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copy Regulations  
11. Copyrighted material or trademarks of any manner or kind without the consent of the copyright  
or trademark owner.  
This list is provided for your convenience and assistance, but it is not all-inclusive, and no liability is  
assumed for its completeness or accuracy. In case of doubt, consult your solicitor.  
Other Countries  
Copying certain documents may be illegal in your country. Penalties of fine or imprisonment may be  
imposed on those found guilty of making such reproductions:  
Currency notes  
Bank notes and cheques  
Bank and government bonds and securities  
Passports and identification cards  
Copyright material or trademarks without the consent of the owner  
Postage stamps and other negotiable instruments  
This list is not inclusive and no liability is assumed for either its completeness or accuracy. In case of  
doubt, contact your legal counsel.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fax Regulations  
Fax Regulations  
United States  
Fax Send Header Requirements  
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or  
other electronic device, including a fax machine, to send any message unless such message clearly  
contains in a margin at the top or bottom of each transmitted page or on the first page of the  
transmission, the date and time it is sent and an identification of the business or other entity, or other  
individual sending the message and the telephone number of the sending machine or such business,  
other entity or individual. The telephone number provided may not be a 900 number or any other  
number for which charges exceed local or long distance transmission charges.  
Data Coupler Information  
This device complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the Administrative  
Council for Terminal Attachments (ACTA). On the cover of this device is a label that contains, among  
other information, a device identifier in the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number  
must be provided to the Telephone Company.  
A plug and jack used to connect this device to the premises wiring and telephone network must comply  
with the applicable FCC Part 68 rules and requirements adopted by the ACTA. A compliant telephone  
cord and modular plug is provided with this device. It is designed to be connected to a compatible  
modular jack that is also compliant. See installation instructions for details.  
You may safely connect the machine to the following standard modular jack: USOC RJ-11C using the  
compliant telephone line cord (with modular plugs) provided with the installation kit. See installation  
instructions for details.  
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is used to determine the number of devices that can be  
connected to a telephone line. Excessive RENs on a telephone line could result in the devices not  
ringing in response to an incoming call. In most but not all areas, the sum of RENs should not exceed  
five (5.0). To be certain of the number of devices that can be connected to a line, as determined by the  
RENs, contact the local Telephone Company. For products approved after July 23, 2001, the REN is part  
of the product identifier that has the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. The digits represented by ## are the  
REN without a decimal point (for example, 03 is a REN of 0.3). For earlier products, the REN is  
separately shown on the label.  
To order the correct service from the local telephone company, you may also have to quote the codes  
listed below:  
Facility Interface Code (FIC) = 02LS2  
Service Order Code (SOC) = 9.0Y  
270  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax Regulations  
CAUTION: Ask your local telephone company for the modular jack type installed on your line.  
Connecting this machine to an unauthorized jack can damage telephone company equipment.  
You, not Xerox, assume all responsibility and/or liability for any damage caused by the connection  
of this machine to an unauthorized jack.  
If this Xerox device causes harm to the telephone network, the Telephone Company will notify you in  
advance that temporary discontinuance of service may be required. But if advance notice is not  
practical, the Telephone Company will notify the customer as soon as possible. Also, you will be advised  
of your right to file a complaint with the FCC if you believe it is necessary.  
The Telephone Company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations or procedures that  
could affect the operation of the device. If this happens, the Telephone Company will provide advance  
notice in order for you to make necessary modifications to maintain uninterrupted service.  
If you experience trouble with this Xerox device, for repair or warranty information, contact the  
appropriate service center; details of which are displayed either on the machine or contained within  
the User Guide. If the device is causing harm to the telephone network, the Telephone Company may  
request that you disconnect the device until the problem is resolved.  
Only a Xerox Service Representative or an authorized Xerox Service provider is authorized to make  
repairs to the printer. This applies at any time during or after the service warranty period. If  
unauthorized repair is performed, the remainder of the warranty period is null and void.  
This device must not be used on party lines. Connection to party line service is subject to state tariffs.  
Contact the state public utility commission, public service commission or corporation commission for  
information.  
Your office could have specially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line. Make sure  
that the installation of this Xerox® equipment does not disable your alarm equipment.  
If you have questions about what could disable alarm equipment, consult your Telephone Company or  
a qualified installer.  
Canada  
This product meets the applicable Industry Canada technical specifications.  
A representative designated by the supplier should coordinate repairs to certified equipment. Repairs  
or alterations made by the user to this device, or device malfunctions, could cause the  
telecommunications company to request you to disconnect the equipment.  
For user protection, make sure that the printer is properly grounded. The electrical ground connections  
of the power utility, telephone lines, and internal metallic water pipe systems, if present, must be  
connected together. This precaution could be vital in rural areas.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to make such connections yourself. Contact the appropriate electric  
inspection authority, or electrician, to make the ground connection.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Fax Regulations  
The REN assigned to each terminal device provides an indication of the maximum number of terminals  
allowed to be connected to a telephone interface. The termination on an interface could consist of any  
combination of devices. The only limitation to the number of devices is the requirement that the sum  
of the RENs of the devices does not exceed 5. For the Canadian REN value, see the label on the  
equipment.  
European Union  
Radio Equipment & Telecommunications Terminal Equipment Directive  
The Facsimile has been approved in accordance with the Council Decision 1999/5/EC for pan-European  
single terminal connection to the public switched telephone network (PSTN). However, due to  
differences between the individual PSTNs provided in different countries, the approval does not give an  
unconditional assurance of successful operation on every PSTN network terminal point.  
In the event of a problem you should contact your authorized local dealer.  
This product has been tested to and is compliant with ES 203 021-1, -2, -3, a specification for terminal  
equipment for use on analog-switched telephone networks in the European Economic Area. This  
product provides a user-adjustable setting of the country code. The country code should be set prior to  
connecting this product to the network. Refer to the customer documentation for the procedure for  
setting the country code.  
Note: Although this product can use either loop disconnect (pulse) or DTMF (tone) signaling, it is  
recommended that it is set to use DTMF signaling. DTMF signaling provides reliable and faster call  
setup. Modification of this device, connection to external control software or to external control  
apparatus not authorized by Xerox, will invalidate its certification.  
South Africa  
This modem must be used in conjunction with an approved surge protection device.  
New Zealand  
1. The grant of a Telepermit for any item of terminal equipment indicates only that Telecom has  
accepted that the item complies with minimum conditions for connection to its network. It  
indicates no endorsement of the product by Telecom, it does not provide any sort of warranty, and  
it does not imply that any Telepermitted product is compatible with all Telecom network services.  
Above all, it provides no assurance that any item will work correctly in all respects with another  
item of Telepermitted equipment of a different make or model.  
The equipment may not be capable of correct operation at the higher data speeds designated.  
33.6 kbps and 56 kbps connections are likely to be restricted to lower bit rates when connected to  
some PSTN implementations. Telecom will accept no responsibility for difficulties that arise in  
such circumstances.  
2. Immediately disconnect this equipment should it become physically damaged, then arrange for  
its disposal or repair.  
3. This modem shall not be used in any manner which could constitute a nuisance to other Telecom  
customers.  
272  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Fax Regulations  
4. This device is equipped with pulse dialing, while the Telecom standard is DTMF tone dialing. There  
is no guarantee that Telecom lines will always continue to support pulse dialing.  
5. Use of pulse dialing, when this equipment is connected to the same line as other equipment, may  
give rise to bell tinkle, or noise, and cause a false answer condition. If you encounter such  
problems, do not contact the Telecom Faults Service.  
6. DTMF tone dialing is the preferred method because it is faster than pulse (decadic) dialing and is  
readily available on almost all New Zealand telephone exchanges.  
WARNING: No ‘111’ or other calls can be made from this device during a mains power failure.  
7. This equipment may not provide for the effective hand-over of a call to another device connected  
to the same line.  
8. Some parameters required for compliance with Telecom Telepermit requirements are dependent  
on the equipment (computer) associated with this device. The associated equipment shall be set  
to operate within the following limits for compliance with Telecom Specifications:  
For repeat calls to the same number:  
There shall be no more than 10 call attempts to the same number within any 30 minute  
period for any single manual call initiation, and  
The equipment shall go on-hook for a period of not less than 30 seconds between the end of  
one attempt and the beginning of the next attempt.  
For automatic calls to different numbers:  
The equipment shall be set to ensure that automatic calls to different numbers are spaced such  
that there is no less than five seconds between the end of one call attempt and the beginning of  
another.  
9. For correct operation, total of the RENs of all devices connected to a single line at any time should  
not exceed five.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Material Safety Data  
Material Safety Data  
For Material Safety Data information regarding your printer, go to:  
North America: www.xerox.com/msds  
European Union: www.xerox.com/environment_europe  
For the Customer Support Center phone numbers, go to www.xerox.com/office/worldcontacts  
274  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Recycling and Disposal  
16  
This chapter includes recycling and disposal information for:  
All Countries  
North America  
European Union  
Other Countries  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
All Countries  
All Countries  
If you are managing the disposal of your Xerox product, please note that the printer may contain lead,  
mercury, perchlorate, and other materials whose disposal may be regulated due to environmental  
considerations. The presence of these materials is fully consistent with global regulations applicable at  
the time that the product was placed on the market. For recycling and disposal information, contact  
your local authorities.  
Perchlorate Material  
This product may contain one or more Perchlorate-containing devices, such as batteries. Special  
handling may apply. Please see www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
276  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
North America  
North America  
Xerox operates an equipment take-back and reuse/recycle program. Contact your Xerox representative  
(call 1-800-ASK-XEROX) to determine if this Xerox product is part of the program.  
For more information about Xerox environmental programs, visit www.xerox.com/environment, or for  
local recycling and disposal information, contact your local authorities.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
European Union  
European Union  
Some equipment may be used in both a domestic/household and a professional/business application.  
Domestic/Household Environment  
Application of this symbol on your equipment is confirmation that you should not dispose  
of the equipment in the normal household waste stream.  
In accordance with European legislation, end of life electrical and electronic equipment  
subject to disposal must be segregated from household waste. Private households within  
EU member states may return used electrical and electronic equipment to designated collection  
facilities free of charge. Please contact your local disposal authority for information. In some member  
states, when you purchase new equipment, your local retailer may be required to take back your old  
equipment free of charge. Please ask your retailer for information.  
Professional/Business Environment  
Application of this symbol on your equipment is confirmation that you must dispose of this  
equipment in compliance with agreed national procedures.  
In accordance with European legislation, end of life electrical and electronic equipment  
subject to disposal must be managed within agreed procedures. Prior to disposal, please contact your  
local reseller or Xerox representative for end of life take-back information.  
Collection and Disposal of Equipment and Batteries  
These symbols on the products and/or accompanying documents mean that used electrical and  
electronic products and batteries should not be mixed with general household waste. For proper  
treatment, recovery, and recycling of old products and used batteries, please take them to applicable  
collection points, in accordance with your national legislation and the Directive 2002/96/EC and  
2006/66/EC.  
By disposing of these products and batteries correctly, you will help to save valuable resources and  
prevent any potential negative effects on human health and the environment which could otherwise  
arise from inappropriate waste handling.  
For more information about collection and recycling of old products and batteries, please contact your  
local municipality, your waste disposal service, or the point of sale where you purchased the items.  
Penalties may be applicable for incorrect disposal of this waste, in accordance with national legislation.  
278  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
European Union  
Business Users in the European Union  
If you wish to discard electrical and electronic equipment, please contact your dealer or supplier for  
further information.  
Disposal Outside of the European Union  
These symbols are only valid in the European Union. If you wish to discard these items, please contact  
your local authorities or dealer and ask for the correct method of disposal.  
Battery Symbol Note  
This wheeled bin symbol may be used in combination with a chemical symbol. This  
establishes compliance with the requirements set out by the Directive.  
Battery Removal  
Batteries should only be replaced by a MANUFACTURER-approved service facility.  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Other Countries  
Other Countries  
Please contact your local waste management authority to request disposal guidance.  
280  
Xerox® WorkCentre® 3215/3225  
User Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Westell Technologies Network Router 36R566 User Manual
Westinghouse Flat Panel Television DW46F1Y2 User Manual
Wolf Convection Oven WKEC2 User Manual
Woods Equipment Lawn Mower ME2052B User Manual
X Micro Tech Computer Drive Bluetooth USB Dongle User Manual
Yamaha Automobile 5RU2819913 User Manual
Zanussi Dishwasher 132713 User Manual
Zanussi Washer FL 1032 User Manual
Zanussi Washer ZWFS 7000 User Manual
Zenith Car Satellite TV System P42W34 User Manual